Yamaha Stereo Receiver 376 User Manual

U
RX-V2700  
AV Receiver  
OWNER’S MANUAL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
10 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided  
for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the  
product and to protect it from overheating, and these  
openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings  
should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed,  
sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not  
be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack  
unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s  
instructions have been adhered to.  
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE  
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE  
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO  
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.  
11 Power Sources – This product should be operated only from  
the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If  
you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home,  
consult your product dealer or local power company. For  
products intended to operate from battery power, or other  
sources, refer to the operating instructions.  
12 Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped  
with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having  
one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the  
power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you  
are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try  
reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact  
your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not  
defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.  
13 Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be  
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched  
by items placed upon or against them, paying particular  
attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the  
point where they exit from the product.  
14 Lightning – For added protection for this product during a  
lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for  
long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and  
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent  
damage to the product due to lightning and power-line  
surges.  
15 Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be  
located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other  
electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such  
power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna  
system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching  
such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be  
fatal.  
16 Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension  
cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result  
in a risk of fire or electric shock.  
17 Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind  
into this product through openings as they may touch  
dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result  
in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on  
the product.  
18 Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself  
as opening or removing covers may expose you to  
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to  
qualified service personnel.  
Explanation of Graphical Symbols  
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an  
equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the  
presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within  
the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient  
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to  
persons.  
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle  
is intended to alert you to the presence of important  
operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in  
the literature accompanying the appliance.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions  
should be read before the product is operated.  
Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions  
should be retained for future reference.  
Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the  
operating instructions should be adhered to.  
Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions  
should be followed.  
Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before  
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.  
Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by  
the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.  
Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water –  
for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or  
laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool;  
and the like.  
Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart,  
stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall,  
causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious  
damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod,  
bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold  
with the product. Any mounting of the product should  
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a  
mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.  
A product and cart combination should be moved with care.  
Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may  
cause the product and cart combination to  
8
9
overturn.  
19 Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the  
wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel  
under the following conditions:  
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,  
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the  
product,  
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,  
Caution-i  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
d) If the product does not operate normally by following  
the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls  
that are covered by the operating instructions as an  
improper adjustment of other controls may result in  
damage and will often require extensive work by a  
qualified technician to restore the product to its normal  
operation,  
24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or  
cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna  
or cable system is grounded so as to provide some  
protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges.  
Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70,  
provides information with regard to proper grounding of the  
mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire  
to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors,  
location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding  
electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode.  
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any  
way, and  
f)  
When the product exhibits a distinct change in  
performance - this indicates a need for service.  
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING  
20 Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required,  
be sure the service technician has used replacement parts  
specified by the manufacturer or have the same  
characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized  
substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other  
hazards.  
ANTENNA  
LEAD IN  
WIRE  
MAST  
21 Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to  
this product, ask the service technician to perform safety  
checks to determine that the product is in proper operating  
condition.  
GROUND  
CLAMP  
ANTENNA  
DISCHARGE UNIT  
(NEC SECTION 810–20)  
22 Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted  
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the  
manufacturer.  
23 Heat – The product should be situated away from heat  
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other  
products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.  
ELECTRIC  
SERVICE  
EQUIPMENT  
GROUNDING CONDUCTORS  
(NEC SECTION 810–21)  
GROUND CLAMPS  
POWER SERVICE GROUNDING  
ELECTRODE SYSTEM  
(NEC ART 250. PART H)  
Note to CATV system installer:  
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system  
installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that  
provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in  
particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be  
connected to the grounding system of the building, as  
close to the point of cable entry as practical.  
NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE  
FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)  
1
IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS  
UNIT!  
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that  
interference will not occur in all installations. If this  
product is found to be the source of interference, which  
can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”,  
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the  
following measures:  
This product, when installed as indicated in the  
instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC  
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by  
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to  
use the product.  
IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to  
accessories and/or another product use only high quality  
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST  
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to  
follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to  
use this product in the USA.  
NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply  
with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15  
for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these  
requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that  
your use of this product in a residential environment will  
not result in harmful interference with other electronic  
devices.  
Relocate either this product or the device that is being  
affected by the interference.  
2
3
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit  
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.  
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient  
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead,  
change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.  
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory  
results, please contact the local retailer authorized to  
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the  
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics  
Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA  
90620.  
The above statements apply ONLY to those products  
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its  
subsidiaries.  
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if  
not installed and used according to the instructions found  
in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the  
operation of other electronic devices.  
Caution-ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.  
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.  
1
2
To assure the finest performance, please read this manual  
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.  
Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean  
place – away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration,  
dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at least  
30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on  
the back of this unit.  
16 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power  
plug can be reached easily.  
17 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on  
common operating errors before concluding that this unit is  
faulty.  
18 Before moving this unit, press MASTER ON/OFF to release it  
outward to the OFF position to turn off this unit, the main  
room, Zone 2 and Zone 3 and then disconnect the AC power  
plug from the AC wall outlet.  
19 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (Asia and General models only)  
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit  
must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging  
into the AC wall outlet. Voltages are as follows:  
................................. 110/120/220/230–240 V AC, 50/60 Hz  
3
4
Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors,  
or transformers to avoid humming sounds.  
Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from  
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in an environment with  
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent  
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical  
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.  
Avoid installing this unit where foreign objects may fall onto  
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or  
splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:  
5
WARNING  
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC  
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN  
OR MOISTURE.  
Other components, as they may cause damage and/or  
discoloration on the surface of this unit.  
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,  
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.  
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid  
may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to  
this unit.  
As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet,  
it is not disconnected from the AC power source even  
if you turn off this unit by MASTER ON/OFF. In this  
state, this unit is designed to consume a very small  
quantity of power.  
6
Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,  
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature  
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,  
and/or personal injury.  
Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections  
are complete.  
Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,  
possibly causing damage.  
Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.  
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS  
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to  
wide slot and fully insert.  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian  
ICES-003.  
7
8
9
10 When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet,  
grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.  
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might  
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.  
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this unit  
with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and may cause  
fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. YAMAHA will  
not be held responsible for any damage resulting from use of  
this unit with a voltage other than specified.  
POUR LES CONSOMMATEURS CANADIENS  
Pour éviter les chocs électriques, introduire la lame la  
plus large de la fiche dans la borne correspondante de  
la prise et pousser jusqu’au fond.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à  
la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
13 To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cord and  
outdoor antennas disconnected from a wall outlet or the unit  
during a lightning storm.  
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified  
YAMAHA service personnel when any service is needed. The  
cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.  
IMPORTANT  
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space  
below.  
MODEL:  
Serial No.:  
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit.  
Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future  
reference.  
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time (i.e.  
vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet.  
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT (DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)  
Responsible Party: Yamaha Electronics Corporation, U.S.A.  
• This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
• Operation is subject to the following conditions:  
– This device may not cause harmful interference.  
– This device must accept any interference received including  
interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Address:  
6660 Orangethorpe Avenue  
Buena Park, CA 90620  
714-522-9105  
Telephone:  
Fax:  
714-670-0108  
Type of Equipment: AV Receiver  
See the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section at the end of this  
manual if interference to radio reception is suspected.  
Model Name:  
RX-V2700  
Caution-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TRADEMARK NOTICES  
Note on Source Code Distribution  
This product includes software code subject to the GNU General  
Public License (GPL) or the GNU Lesser General Public License  
(LGPL). The copy, distribution, or change of this software code is  
licensed under the terms of the GPL or the LGPL. The source  
code is available at the following website:  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks  
of Dolby Laboratories.  
http://www.global.yamaha.com/download/  
The source code is also available on a physical media (such as a  
CD-ROM) at actual cost.  
Contact: AV products division, YAMAHA CORPORATION,  
10-1 Nakazawa-cho, Hamamatsu 430-8650, Japan  
Manufactured under license from Digital Theater Systems, Inc.  
“DTS”, “DTS-ES”, “NEO:6”, and “DTS 96/24” are trademarks  
of Digital Theater Systems, Inc. Copyright 1996, 2003 Digital  
Theater Systems, Inc. All right reserved.  
In principle, the source code is offered for 3 years from the day of  
purchase.  
®
iPod  
“iPod” is a trademark of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in the  
U.S. and other countries.  
We Want You Listening For A Lifetime  
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries  
Association’s Consumer Electronics Group want  
you to get the most out of your equipment by  
playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound  
come through loud and clear without annoying  
blaring or distortion – and, most importantly,  
without affecting your sensitive hearing. Since hearing damage  
from loud sounds is often undetectable until it is too late,  
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer  
Electronics Group recommend you to avoid prolonged exposure  
from excessive volume levels.  
MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from  
Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson.  
This receiver supports network connections.  
“HDMI”, the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of YAMAHA  
CORPORATION.  
The XM name and related logos are registered trademarks of XM  
Satellite Radio Inc.  
Neural Surroundname and related logos are trademarks owned  
by Neural Audio Corporation.  
Windows XP, Windows Media Audio, Windows Media Connect  
are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft  
corporation in the United States and/or countries.  
1 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
USING AUDIO FEATURES............................... 52  
INTRODUCTION  
Enjoying pure hi-fi sound........................................ 52  
Adjusting the tonal quality ...................................... 52  
Adjusting the speaker level...................................... 53  
Enjoying multi-channel sources  
in 2-channel stereo .............................................. 53  
Selecting the Compressed Music  
FEATURES .............................................................4  
GETTING STARTED............................................5  
Supplied accessories.................................................. 5  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS..........................6  
Front panel................................................................. 6  
Remote control .......................................................... 8  
Zone 2/Zone 3 remote control ................................. 10  
Preparing the remote control ................................... 11  
Front panel display .................................................. 12  
Rear panel................................................................ 14  
Enhancer mode.................................................... 54  
Selecting the night listening mode........................... 55  
FM/AM TUNING ................................................. 56  
FM/AM controls and functions ............................... 56  
Automatic tuning..................................................... 57  
Manual tuning.......................................................... 58  
Automatic preset tuning........................................... 59  
Manual preset tuning ............................................... 60  
Selecting preset stations........................................... 61  
Exchanging preset stations ...................................... 62  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING .................. 63  
Connecting the XM Passport System...................... 63  
XM Satellite Radio controls and functions.............. 64  
Activating XM Satellite Radio ................................ 65  
Basic XM Satellite Radio operations....................... 67  
Setting the XM Satellite Radio preset channels ...... 72  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio information...... 73  
USING iPod........................................................... 75  
Controlling iPod ...................................................... 75  
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES.............. 77  
Navigating the network and USB menus ................ 77  
Using a PC server or YAMAHA MCX-2000 ......... 79  
Using the Internet Radio.......................................... 80  
Using a USB memory device  
PREPARATION  
CONNECTIONS...................................................15  
Placing speakers ...................................................... 15  
Connecting speakers................................................ 16  
Using bi-amplification connections......................... 19  
Information on jacks and cable plugs...................... 20  
Information on HDMI ............................................. 21  
Audio and video signal flow.................................... 22  
Connecting a TV monitor or projector .................... 23  
Connecting other components ................................. 24  
Connecting a multi-format player  
or an external decoder ......................................... 28  
Connecting a YAMAHA iPod universal dock ........ 29  
Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel .... 29  
Connecting the network........................................... 30  
Connecting the FM and AM antennas..................... 31  
Connecting the power cable .................................... 32  
Setting the speaker impedance ................................ 33  
Turning on and off the power.................................. 34  
AUTO SETUP.......................................................35  
Using Auto Setup..................................................... 35  
or a USB portable audio player........................... 81  
Using shortcut buttons............................................. 81  
RECORDING ....................................................... 83  
ADVANCED OPERATION  
BASIC OPERATION  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS.... 84  
Selecting decoders................................................... 84  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI)  
PLAYBACK..........................................................40  
Basic procedure ....................................................... 40  
Selecting audio input jacks (AUDIO SELECT)...... 42  
Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT component......... 43  
Using your headphones ........................................... 43  
Muting the audio output .......................................... 43  
Operating the amplifier functions of this unit  
by using the graphical user interface (GUI)  
screen................................................................... 44  
Playing video sources  
in the background of an audio source.................. 45  
Using the sleep timer ............................................... 45  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS.............................46  
Selecting sound field programs ............................... 46  
Sound field program descriptions............................ 47  
Enjoying unprocessed input sources........................ 51  
SCREEN............................................................ 87  
Stereo/Surround (Stereo/Surround menu) ............... 88  
Input Select.............................................................. 94  
Manual Setup (Sound)............................................. 97  
Manual Setup (Video) ........................................... 101  
Manual Setup (Basic) ............................................ 104  
Manual Setup (NET/USB)..................................... 109  
Manual Setup (Option).......................................... 111  
System Memory..................................................... 115  
Signal Info. (Input signal information).................. 116  
Language ............................................................... 117  
2 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES................. 118  
Controlling this unit, a TV,  
or other components .......................................... 118  
Setting remote control codes ................................. 120  
Programming codes from other remote controls ... 122  
Changing source names in the display window..... 123  
Macro programming features ................................ 124  
Clearing configurations ......................................... 127  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION .. 130  
Connecting the Zone 2 and Zone 3 components ... 130  
Controlling Zone 2 or Zone 3................................ 131  
ADVANCED SETUP ......................................... 134  
Using ADVANCED SETUP................................. 134  
Setting remote control ID ...................................... 137  
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION  
TROUBLESHOOTING..................................... 139  
RESETTING THE SYSTEM............................ 149  
GLOSSARY ........................................................ 150  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM  
INFORMATION ............................................ 153  
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER  
INFORMATION ............................................ 154  
SPECIFICATIONS ............................................ 155  
APPENDIX  
(at the end of this manual)  
SOUND OUTPUT  
IN EACH SOUND FIELD PROGRAM ............ i  
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE.................. v  
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC  
LICENSE............................................................ vi  
LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODE ............. ix  
About this manual  
yindicates a tip for your operation.  
• Some operations can be performed by using either the  
buttons on the front panel or the ones on the remote  
control. In case the button names differ between the front  
panel and the remote control, the button name on the  
remote control is given in parentheses.  
• This manual is printed prior to production. Design and  
specifications are subject to change in part as a result of  
improvements, etc. In case of differences between the  
manual and product, the product has priority.  
• This unit equips GUI display menu language switching  
capability. In this manual, the illustrations of the GUI are  
examples when you set the GUI language to English.  
3 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FEATURES  
FEATURES  
Built-in 7-channel power amplifier  
Network features  
Minimum RMS output power  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 )  
Front: 140 W + 140 W  
NETWORK port to connect a PC and YAMAHA MCX-2000  
or access the Internet Radio via a LAN  
DHCP automatic or manual network configuration  
Center: 140 W  
Surround: 140 W + 140 W  
Surround back: 140 W + 140 W  
USB features  
USB port to connect a USB memory device or a USB portable  
audio player  
Sound field programs  
Proprietary YAMAHA technology for the creation of sound  
fields  
Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX decoder  
DTS/DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS Neo:6,  
DTS 96/24 decoder  
Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic II/Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
decoder  
Other features  
YPAO (YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) for  
automatic speaker setup  
192-kHz/24-bit D/A converter  
GUI (graphical user interfece) menus that allows you to  
optimize this unit to suit your individual audio/video system  
GUI display menu language switching capability  
(English, Japanese, French, German, Spanish and Russian)  
6 or 8-channel additional input jacks for discrete multi-  
channel input  
Analog video interlace/progressive conversion from 480i  
(NTSC)/576i (PAL) to 480p/576p  
S-video signal input/output capability  
Component video input/output capability includes (3  
COMPONENT VIDEO INs and 1 MONITOR OUT)  
Optical and coaxial digital audio signal jacks  
Pure Direct mode for pure hi-fi sound for all sources  
Cinema and music night listening modes  
Compressed Music Enhancer mode to improve the sound  
quality of compression artifacts (such as the MP3 format) to  
that of a high-quality stereo  
Remote control with preset remote control codes, learning,  
macro and buttons and display backlight capability  
ZONE 2/ZONE 3 custom installation facility  
Zone switching capability between the main zone and  
ZONE 2/ZONE 3 using ZONE CONTROLS  
Zone 2 OSD (on-screen display) capability  
Sleep timer  
Neural Surround decoder (U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
Virtual CINEMA DSP  
SILENT CINEMA  
Sophisticated AM/FM tuner  
40-station random and direct preset tuning  
Automatic preset tuning  
Preset station shifting capability (preset editing)  
XM Satellite Radio  
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
XM Satellite Radio tuning capability (using the “XM Passport  
System” sold separately)  
Neural Surround decoder to play back the surround sound  
content of XM Satellite Radio broadcasts in multi-channels,  
resulting in a full surround sound experience  
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface)  
HDMI interface for standard, enhanced or  
high-definition video (includes 1080p video signal  
transmission) as well as multi-channel digital audio based on  
HDMI version 1.2a  
Analog video to HDMI digital video up-conversion  
(composite video S-video component video HDMI  
digital video) capability for monitor out  
Analog video up-scaling from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) or  
480p/576p to 720p or 1080i  
iPod controlling capability  
DOCK terminal to connect a YAMAHA iPod universal dock  
(such as the YDS-10, sold separately), which supports iPod  
(Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod mini  
4 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GETTING STARTED  
GETTING STARTED  
Supplied accessories  
Check that you received all of the following parts.  
Remote control  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
Zone 2/Zone 3  
remote control  
Batteries (6)  
(AAA, LR03)  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
POWER  
STANDBY  
TUNER  
DTV  
CD  
CD-R  
SELECT  
MD/T  
APE NET/USB  
CBL/SAT  
DVR/VCR  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
VCR  
1
2
DVD  
V-AUX/DOCK  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET  
VOLUME  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
SRCH MODE  
A/B/C/D/E  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
MUTE  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
ID1 ID2  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
3
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
Speaker terminal wrench  
Power cable  
Optimizer microphone  
Indoor FM antenna  
(U.S.A., Canada, China, Asia, General,  
and Korea models)  
Indoor FM antenna  
(Europe, U.K. and Australia models)  
AM loop antenna  
5 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Front panel  
This section describes only the amplifier controls and functions of this unit. See the following pages for details about  
other control and functions.  
• AM/FM tuning .......................................... see page 56  
• XM satellite radio tuning .......................... see page 64  
1
2
3
4 5 6  
7
8
9
0
A B  
C
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
FM/AM  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S VIDEO  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
(U.S.A. model)  
D
E
F
G
H
I
1 MASTER ON/OFF  
4 AUDIO SELECT  
Turns this unit on or off (see page 34).  
Toggles the priority for the type of audio input jack  
between “AUTO”, “HDMI”, “COAX/OPT” and  
“ANALOG” when one component is connected to two or  
2 MAIN ZONE ON/OFF  
Turns on the main zone or sets it to the standby mode  
5 TONE CONTROL  
Notes  
Adjusts the bass/treble balance of the front left, front right  
and center channels in conjunction with the PROGRAM  
• In the standby mode, this unit consumes a small amount of  
power in order to receive infrared signals from the remote  
control.  
• When you turn on this unit, there will be a 4 to 5-second delay  
before this unit can reproduce sound.  
6 REC OUT/ZONE2  
Selects the input source you want to direct to the audio/  
video recorder and Zone 2 outputs independently of the  
input source you are listening to or watching in the main  
• This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF is  
pressed inward to the ON position.  
3 INPUT selector  
Selects the desired input source (see page 40).  
7 STRAIGHT  
Turns the sound field programs off or on. When the  
“STRAIGHT” mode is selected, 2-channel or multi-  
channel input signals are output directly from their  
respective speakers without effect processing (see  
page 51).  
6 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
8 MULTI ZONE buttons  
D PROGRAM selector  
• Selects sound field programs (see page 46).  
• Adjusts the bass/treble balance in conjunction with  
TONE CONTROL (see page 52).  
ZONE 2 ON/OFF  
Turns on Zone 2 only or sets it to the standby mode  
E OPTIMIZER MIC jack  
ZONE 3 ON/OFF  
Turns on Zone 3 only or sets it to the standby mode  
Use to connect and input audio signals from the supplied  
optimizer microphone in the “Auto Setup” procedure (see  
Note  
F
PHONES jack  
Outputs audio signals for private listening with  
These buttons are operational only when MASTER ON/OFF  
is pressed inward to the ON position.  
ZONE CONTROLS  
G VIDEO AUX jacks  
Switches the zone you want to control between the  
main zone, Zone 2 and Zone 3 (see page 131).  
Input audio and video signals from a portable external  
source such as a game console or a video camera  
y
After you press ZONE CONTROLS, the indicator for the  
currently selected zone flashes in the front panel display for  
approximately 5 seconds. While the indicator is flashing,  
perform the desired operation.  
y
To reproduce the source signals input at these jacks, select  
V-AUX” as the input source.  
Note  
9 Front panel display  
The audio signals input at the DOCK terminal on the rear panel  
take priority over the ones input at the VIDEO AUX jacks.  
Shows information about the operational status of this unit  
H USB port  
0 ENHANCER  
Use to connect a USB memory device or a USB portable  
Turns on or off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
I VOLUME  
A Remote control sensor  
Controls the output level of all audio channels.  
Receives signals from the remote control (see page 11).  
y
B NIGHT  
This does not affect the AUDIO OUT (REC) level.  
Turns on or off the night listening modes (see page 55).  
Opening and closing the front panel  
door  
When you want to use the controls behind the front panel  
door, open the door by gently pressing on the lower part of  
the panel. Keep the door closed when not using these  
controls.  
C PURE DIRECT  
Turns on or off the Pure Direct mode (see page 52).  
To open, press gently on the lower part of the panel.  
7 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Remote control  
Remote control controls and functions  
This section describes only the amplifier controls and functions of this unit. See the following pages for details about  
other control and functions.  
• AM/FM tuning .......................................... see page 56  
Note  
• XM satellite radio tuning .......................... see page 64  
• Controlling a TV ..................................... see page 118  
area below depends on the operation mode selector position. Set  
• Controlling other components ................. see page 119  
The operation mode of the remote control buttons in the shaded  
the operation mode selector to AMP to control this unit.  
• Controlling option components ............... see page 120  
1 Infrared window  
Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the  
component you want to operate (see page 11).  
1
D
2
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
POWER  
STANDBY  
E
F
G
2 TRANSMIT indicator  
Flashes while the remote control is sending infrared  
signals.  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
3 Input selector buttons  
Select the input source you want to control.  
3
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
y
The selected input source name appears in the display window on  
the remote control showing which source is currently operational.  
4 Display window  
Shows the name of the selected input source that you can  
control.  
SELECT  
4
5
H
I
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
VOLUME  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
5 LIGHT  
Lights up the remote control buttons and the display  
window.  
J
K
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
6 LEVEL  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted and sets the  
6
7
L
M
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
7 Cursor buttons k/ n/ l/ h, ENTER  
Move the items or cursor and adjust the parameters in the  
GUI screens or front panel display.  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
N
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
8 Sound field program selector buttons  
3
4
8
1
2
STEREO  
EXTD SUR.  
SELECT  
SUR. DECODE  
O
P
Q
R
8
5
6
7
9 SUR. DECODE  
Activates decoders to play back 2-channel sources in  
9
0
MEMORY  
NIGHT ENHANCER  
1
2
0
+10  
ENT  
9
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
0 MEMORY 1/2  
Recalls “MEMORY 1” or “MEMORY 2” of “System  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
A
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
S
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
B
C
A Network and USB input selector buttons  
Select the sub input source of NET/USB (see page 78).  
t
U
PC/MCX  
Selects a PC server or YAMAHA MCX-2000 as the  
sub input source of NET/USB.  
(U.S.A. model)  
8 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
NET RADIO  
SOURCE  
Selects the Internet radio as the sub input source of  
NET/USB.  
Operates the component selected with an input  
selector button (see page 119).  
USB  
TV  
Selects a USB memory device or a USB portable  
audio player as the sub input source of NET/USB.  
Operates the TV assigned to either DTV or PHONO  
Notes  
Notes  
• Press NET/USB to select “NET/USB” as the input source  
before you press any of the network and USB input selector  
buttons stated above to select the corresponding sub input  
source of NET/USB.  
• When you press any of the network and USB input selector  
buttons, the contents previously played for the corresponding  
sub input source of NET/USB is automatically played.  
• To set the remote control codes for other components, see  
• When you set the remote control codes for both DTV and  
PHONO (see page 120), priority is given to the one set for  
DTV.  
J VOLUME +/–  
Increases or decreases the volume level.  
B MACRO ON/OFF  
Turns on or off the macro function (see page 124).  
K MUTE  
Mutes the audio output. Press again to restore the audio  
output to the previous volume level (see page 43).  
C MACRO  
Programs a series of operations to be controlled with a  
L PURE DIRECT  
Turns on or off the pure direct mode (see page 52).  
D STANDBY  
Sets the main zone to the standby mode (see page 34).  
M SET MENU  
Note  
N STRAIGHT  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
Turns the sound field programs off or on. When the  
“STRAIGHT” mode is selected, 2-channel or multi-  
channel input signals are output directly from their  
respective speakers without effect processing (see  
E POWER  
Note  
O EXTD SUR.  
Switches between 5.1 and 6.1/7.1-channel playback of  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
F AUDIO SEL  
P SELECT  
Toggles the priority for the type of audio input jack  
between “AUTO”, “HDMI”, “COAX/OPT” and  
“ANALOG” when one component is connected to two or  
more input jacks (see page 42).  
Selects decoders for 2-channel sources (see pages 84 and  
Q ENHANCER  
Turns on or off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
G SLEEP  
Sets the sleep timer (see page 45).  
R NIGHT  
H SELECT k/ n  
Turns on or off the night listening modes (see page 55).  
Selects another input source that you can control  
independently of the input source selected with the input  
selector buttons.  
S RENAME  
Changes the name of the input source in the display  
I Operation mode selector  
Selects the operation mode of the remote control buttons  
in the shaded area.  
T CLEAR  
Clears remote control functions acquired from the learn,  
AMP  
U LEARN  
Operates the amplifier function of this unit.  
Programs remote control codes of functions from other  
9 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Zone 2/Zone 3 remote control  
This section describes the function of each control on the  
Zone 2/Zone 3 remote control used to control the amplifier  
functions of Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
See the following pages for details about other controls  
and functions.  
1 Input selector buttons  
Select the desired input source of Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
2 ID1/ID2 switch  
Switches the remote control ID between ID1 and ID2  
• AM/FM tuning ........................................ see page 56  
• XM Satellite Radio tuning ...................... see page 64  
3 POWER  
Turns on Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
Note  
POWER  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
3
STANDBY  
NET/USB  
CD  
TUNER  
DTV  
CD-R  
MD/TAPE  
DVD  
4 STANDBY  
Sets Zone 2 or Zone 3 to the standby mode.  
4
CBL/SAT  
1
Note  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
V-AUX/DOCK  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
5 VOLUME +/–  
Increases or decreases the volume level of Zone 2 or  
Zone 3.  
PRESET  
VOLUME  
5
6
6 MUTE  
A/B/C/D/E  
MUTE  
Mutes the sound of Zone 2 or Zone 3. Press again to  
restore the audio output to the previous volume level.  
7 ZONE 2/ZONE 3 switch  
Switches between the operation mode of Zone 2 and that  
of Zone 3.  
ID1  
ID2  
ZONE 2 ZONE 3  
2
7
(U.S.A. model)  
10 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Preparing the remote control  
Installing batteries in the remote control  
Notes  
• Change all of the batteries if you notice the following  
conditions:  
– the operation range of the remote control decreases.  
– the TRANSMIT indicator does not flash or its light becomes  
dim.  
2
• Do not use old batteries together with new ones.  
• Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and  
manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as  
these different types of batteries may have the same shape and  
color.  
1
3
• We strongly recommend using alkaline batteries.  
• If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid  
touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with  
clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before  
installing new batteries.  
• Do not throw away batteries with general house waste; dispose  
of them correctly in accordance with your local regulations.  
• If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2  
minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control,  
the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory  
is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the remote control code  
and program any acquired functions that may have been  
cleared.  
1
2
Press the  
compartment cover off.  
part and slide the battery  
Insert the four supplied batteries  
(AAA, LR03) according to the polarity  
markings (+ and –) on the inside of the  
battery compartment.  
3
Slide the cover back until it snaps into place.  
Using the remote control  
The remote control transmits a directional infrared ray.  
Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote  
control sensor on this unit during operation.  
Installing batteries in the Zone 2/Zone 3  
remote control  
Remote control sensor  
1
3
2
Approximately 6 m (20 ft)  
30  
30  
1
2
Take off the battery compartment cover.  
Insert the two supplied batteries (AAA, LR03)  
according to the polarity markings  
(+ and –) on the inside of the battery  
compartment.  
Notes  
• Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control.  
• Do not drop the remote control.  
• Do not leave or store the remote control in the following types  
of conditions:  
– places of high humidity, such as near a bath  
– places of high temperatures, such as near a heater or stove  
– places of extremely low temperatures  
– dusty places  
3
Snap the battery compartment cover back  
into place.  
11 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Front panel display  
Note  
The XM indicator is only applicable to the U.S.A. and Canada models and the cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up only when  
“XM” is selected as the input source. For details, see “Basic XM Satellite Radio operations” on page 67.  
1
2 3  
4
5
6
7
RECOUT  
DVR/VCR 2 VCR 1 CBL/SAT DTV DVD  
XM  
NET/USB V-AUX  
MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
DOCK  
neural  
TUNED STEREO  
AUTO MEMORY  
PS  
VIRTUAL  
YPAO HiFi DSP SILENT  
dB  
ENHANCER CINEMA  
ZONE2 PTY  
ZONE3 RT  
VOLUME MUTE  
DIGITAL  
DSD  
PCM  
WMA  
96/24  
PL  
x
EX  
DISCRETE  
LL C R  
LFE SL SB SR  
NIGHT  
CT  
MATRIX  
96  
24  
SLEEP EON  
PTY HOLD  
MP3  
A
8
9
0
L
TUNED STEREO  
AUTO MEMORY  
PS  
neural  
B
C
D
E
H
I
VIRTUAL  
YPAO ENHANCER  
HiFi DSP  
M
ZONE2 PTY  
ZONE3 RT  
SILENT  
CINEMA  
DIGITAL  
PL  
N
O
P
NIGHT  
CT  
DSD  
PCM  
WMA  
J
x
EX  
SLEEP EON  
PTY HOLD  
DISCRETE  
MATRIX  
F
96  
24  
K
MP3  
G
A........ U.S.A. and Canada models only  
P........ U.K. and Europe models only  
1 HDMI indicator  
8 Multi-information display  
Lights up when the signal of the selected input source is  
input at HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN 3 jacks  
Shows the name of the current sound field program and  
other information when adjusting or changing settings.  
9 96/24 indicator  
2 RECOUT indicator  
Lights up when a DTS 96/24 signal is input to this unit.  
Lights up when this unit is in the recording input source  
selecting mode (see page 83).  
0 Input channel and speaker indicators  
Presence speaker indicators  
3 DOCK indicator  
L C R  
LFE SL SB SR  
Lights up when you station your iPod in a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately)  
connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit  
Input channel indicators  
Surround back speaker indicators  
Input channel indicators  
Indicate the channel components of the current digital  
input signal.  
4 Battery charge indicator  
Lights up when this unit charges the battery of the  
stationed iPod in the standby mode of this unit (see  
Presence and surround back speaker  
indicators  
5 Input source indicators  
The corresponding cursor lights up to show the currently  
selected input source.  
Light up according to the number of presence and  
surround back speakers set for “Presence” (see  
“Speaker Set” when “Test Tone” in “Basic” is set to  
6 VOLUME level indicator  
Indicates the current volume level.  
y
7 MUTE indicator  
Flashes while the MUTE function is on (see page 43).  
You can make settings for the presence and surround back  
speakers automatically by running “Auto Setup” (see page 35) or  
manually by adjusting settings for “Presence” (see page 106) and  
“Surround Back” (see page 106) in “Speaker Set”.  
12 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
A neural indicator  
I Headphones indicator  
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
Lights up when the Neural Surround decoder is activated  
Lights up when headphones are connected (see page 43).  
J SILENT CINEMA indicator  
Lights up when headphones are connected and a sound  
B DSP indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the DSP  
sound field programs are selected.  
K DTS decoder indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the DTS  
decoders of this unit function.  
CINEMA DSP indicator  
Lights up when you select a CINEMA DSP sound  
field program (see page 47).  
L Tuner indicators  
Lights up when this unit is in the FM, AM or XM Satellite  
Radio tuning mode.  
HiFi DSP indicator  
Lights up when you select a HiFi DSP sound field  
TUNED indicator  
Lights up when this unit is tuned into a station  
C VIRTUAL indicator  
Lights up when Virtual CINEMA DSP is active (see  
STEREO indicator  
Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal  
for an FM stereo broadcast while the AUTO indicator  
D YPAO indicator  
Lights up when you run “Auto Setup” and when the  
speaker settings set in “Auto Setup” are used without any  
AUTO indicator  
Lights up when this unit is in the automatic tuning  
E ENHANCER indicator  
Lights up when the Compressed Music Enhancer mode is  
MEMORY indicator  
Flashes to show that a station can be stored  
F Signal format indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when this unit is  
reproducing DSD (Direct Stream Digital), PCM (Pulse  
Code Modulation), WMA (Windows Media Audio), WAV  
(RIFF Wave Form Audio) or MP3 (MPEG-1 Audio Layer-  
3) audio signals.  
M ZONE2/ZONE3 indicators  
Lights up when Zone 2 or Zone 3 is turned on  
N NIGHT indicator  
Lights up when you select a night listening mode  
G Dolby decoder indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the Dolby  
decoders of this unit function.  
O SLEEP indicator  
Lights up while the sleep timer is on (see page 45).  
H Sound field indicators  
Light up to indicate the active DSP sound fields.  
P Radio Data System indicators  
(U.K. and Europe models only)  
Presence DSP sound field  
Listening position  
PS, PTY, RT and CT  
Light up according to the selected Radio Data System  
display mode.  
Surround left  
DSP sound field  
Surround right  
DSP sound field  
EON  
Surround back DSP sound field  
Lights up when the EON data service is being  
received.  
PTY HOLD  
Lights up while searching for the Radio Data System  
stations in the PTY SEEK mode.  
13 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Rear panel  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
ANTENNA  
DVD  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
VCR 1 OUT IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT MONITOR OUT  
IN  
MONITOR OUT  
Y
CBL/SAT  
DVD  
DTV  
A
B
C
AC IN  
FM  
GND  
AM  
Y
SVIDEO  
VIDEO  
P
B
P
B
SPEAKERS  
IN  
OUT  
(REC)  
SP1  
PRESENCE  
(PLAY)  
+
+
R
L
WRENCH  
HOLDER  
HDMI  
IN3  
MD/  
TAPE  
PR  
PR  
L
R
IN  
OUT  
IN  
OUT  
REMOTE  
1
2
CBL/  
SAT  
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
CENTER  
+
+
+
ZONE  
VIDEO  
SINGLE  
FRONT(6CH)  
ZONE 2  
ZONE 3  
CENTER  
SURROUND  
CENTER  
FRONT  
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
GND  
PHONO  
CD  
CD-R  
IN2  
L
R
AC OUTLETS  
DTV  
IN1  
SURROUND  
FRONT  
+
+
+
+
R
R
L
L
IN(PLAY)  
AUDIO  
SUB  
SUB  
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
OUT(REC)  
R
SP2  
L
WOOFER  
SB(8CH)  
WOOFER  
MULTI CH INPUT  
PRE OUT  
ZONE OUT  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
DOCK  
DIGITAL INPUT  
+
DVD  
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
CBL/  
MD/  
TAPE  
DVR/  
CD  
CD  
DVD  
DTV  
DVD  
5
6
CD-R  
1
2
3
4
7
8
VCR2  
SAT  
OUT  
NETWORK  
1
2
CONTROL OUT  
RS-232C  
(U.S.A. model)  
8
9 0 A  
B
C
D
E
F
ZONE  
VIDEO  
FRONT(6CH)  
ZONE 2  
ZONE 3  
CENTER  
SURROUND  
CENTER  
FRONT  
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
SUB  
SUB  
WOOFER  
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
WOOFER  
SB(8CH)  
MULTI CH INPUT  
PRE OUT  
ZONE OUT  
G
H
I
1 COMPONENT VIDEO jacks  
B NETWORK port  
See pages 23 and 24 for connection information.  
Use to connect a network cable for network connections.  
See page 30 for connection information.  
20 Audio component jacks  
C XM jack (U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
See page 63 for connection information.  
3 Video component jacks  
D DIGITAL INPUT/OUTPUT jacks  
See pages 23 and 24 for connection information.  
See page 24 for connection information.  
4 ANTENNA terminals  
E CONTROL OUT jack  
This is a control expansion terminal for custom  
installation.  
5 WRENCH HOLDER  
Use to hook the supplied speaker terminal wrench when  
F RS-232C terminal  
This is a control expansion terminal for factory use only.  
Consult your dealer for details.  
6 VOLTAGE SELECTOR  
(Asia and General models only)  
G Speaker terminals  
See page 16 for connection information.  
7 AC IN/OUTLET(S)  
H MULTI CH INPUT jacks  
See page 28 for connection information.  
8 HDMI connectors  
I PRE OUT jacks  
See page 27 for connection information.  
9 REMOTE jacks  
J ZONE OUT jacks  
See page 130 for connection information.  
A DOCK terminal  
14 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
CONNECTIONS  
Placing speakers  
The speaker layout below shows the speaker setting we  
recommend. You can use it to enjoy CINEMA DSP and  
multi-channel audio sources.  
Front left and right speakers (FL and FR)  
The front speakers are used for the main source sound plus  
effect sounds. Place these speakers at an equal distance from  
the ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker  
from each side of the video monitor should be the same.  
PL  
PR  
C
FL  
FR  
Center speaker (C)  
The center speaker is for the center channel sounds  
(dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical  
to use a center speaker, you can do without it. Best results,  
however, are obtained with the full system. Place the  
center speaker centrally between the front speakers and as  
close to the monitor as possible, such as directly over or  
under it.  
30˚  
SL  
SL  
SR  
SR  
60˚  
80˚  
Surround left and right speakers (SL and SR)  
The surround speakers are used for effect and surround  
sounds. Place these speakers behind your listening  
position, facing slightly inwards, about 1.8 m (6 ft) above  
the floor.  
SBL  
SBR  
30 cm (12 in) or more  
Surround back left and right speakers  
(SBL and SBR)  
PR  
FR  
SL  
The surround back speakers supplement the surround  
speakers and provide more realistic front-to-back  
transitions. Place these speakers directly behind the  
listening position and at the same height as the surround  
speakers. They should be positioned at least 30 cm (12 in)  
apart. Ideally, they should be positioned at the same width  
as that of the front speakers.  
PL  
SW  
SR  
SBR  
FL  
C
SBL  
Presence left and right speakers (PL and PR)  
The presence speakers supplement the sound from the front  
speakers with extra ambient effects produced by CINEMA  
DSP (see page 153). These effects include sounds that  
filmmakers intend to locate a little farther back behind the  
screen in order to create more theater-like ambience. Place  
these speakers at the front of the room about 0.5 to 1 m (1  
to 3 ft) outside the front speakers, facing slightly inward,  
and about 1.8 m (6 ft) above the floor.  
1.8 m (6 ft)  
0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)  
PL  
0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)  
PR  
Subwoofer (SW)  
The use of a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier, such as  
the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer  
System, is effective not only for reinforcing bass  
frequencies from any or all channels, but also for high  
fidelity sound reproduction of the LFE (low-frequency  
effect) channel included in Dolby Digital and DTS  
sources. The position of the subwoofer is not so critical,  
because low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it  
is better to place the subwoofer near the front speakers.  
Turn it slightly toward the center of the room to reduce  
wall reflections.  
FL  
FR  
C
1.8 m (6 ft)  
15 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting speakers  
Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are faulty,  
no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound will be  
unnatural and lack bass.  
CAUTION  
Before connecting the speakers, make sure that this unit is turned off (see page 34).  
Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other or do not let them touch any metal part of this  
unit. This could damage this unit and/or speakers.  
Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of speaker still creates interference with the  
monitor, place the speakers away from the monitor.  
If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, be sure to set “SPEAKER IMP.” to “6MIN” before using this unit  
(see page 33). 4 ohm speakers can be also used as the front speakers (see page 135).  
Notes  
• A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables running side by side. Cables are colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a  
stripe, groove or ridge. Connect the striped (grooved, etc.) cable to the “+” (red) terminals of this unit and your speaker. Connect the  
plain cable to the “–” (black) terminals.  
• The low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “Small” or to “None” in “Speaker Set” (see pages 105 and 106) are directed to the  
speakers selected in “Bass Out” (see page 107).  
You can connect both surround back and presence speakers to this unit, however they do not output sound simultaneously. You can set  
to prioritize either set of speakers using the “PR/SB Priority” parameter in “Audio Option” (see page 101).  
You can use the PRESENCE terminals to connect the Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers as well as the presence speakers (see page 130).  
Presence speakers  
Right  
Left  
Surround back speakers  
Subwoofer  
Left  
Right  
Center speaker  
SPEAKERS  
SP1  
+
+
+
PRESENCE  
R
L
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
CENTER  
+
+
SINGLE  
SURROUND  
FRONT  
+
+
+
+
R
R
L
L
SUB  
WOOFER  
R
SP2  
L
PRE OUT  
+
(U.S.A. model)  
Zone 2 or Zone 3  
speakers  
Right  
Left  
Surround speakers  
Right  
Left  
Front speakers  
16 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
FRONT terminals  
Connect front left and right speakers to these terminals.  
Connecting the speaker cable  
1
Remove approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) of  
CENTER terminals  
Connect a center speaker to these terminals.  
insulation from the end of each speaker  
cable and then twist the exposed wires of the  
cable together to prevent short circuits.  
SURROUND terminals  
Connect surround left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
10 mm (0.4 in)  
SURROUND BACK terminals  
Connect surround back left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
Note  
When you use a surround back speaker, connect the speaker to the  
left SURROUND BACK terminal (SINGLE).  
2
Loosen the knob using the supplied speaker  
terminal wrench.  
PRESENCE terminals  
Connect presence left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
Speaker terminal wrench  
SUBWOOFER jack  
Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier (such as the  
YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System)  
to this jack.  
Red: positive (+)  
Black: negative (–)  
3
4
Insert one bare wire into the hole on the side  
of each terminal.  
Tighten the knob to secure the wire using the  
supplied speaker terminal wrench.  
17 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the banana plug  
(except U.K., Europe, Asia and Korea  
models)  
The banana plug is a single-pole electrical connector  
widely used to terminate speaker cables.  
5
Hook the speaker terminal wrench onto the  
WRENCH HOLDER on the rear panel of this  
unit when not in use.  
Banana plug  
1
Tighten the knob using the supplied speaker  
terminal wrench.  
Connecting to the SP2 speaker  
terminals  
Connect Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers to these terminals (see  
Speaker terminal wrench  
1
Open the tab.  
Red: positive (+)  
Black: negative (–)  
Red: positive (+)  
Black: negative (–)  
2
Insert the banana plug connector into the  
end of the corresponding terminal.  
2
Insert one bare wire into the hole on the  
terminal.  
y
You can also use the banana plug with the SP2 speaker terminals.  
Open the tab and then insert one banana plug into the hole on the  
terminal. Do not close the tab after connecting the banana plug.  
3
Close the tab to secure the wire.  
18 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Using bi-amplification connections  
Some of the speakers have speaker wire connections that  
allow bi-amplification to enhance the performance of the  
speaker system. This unit allows you to make bi-  
amplification connection to one speaker system. Check if  
your speakers support bi-amplification. As these speakers  
are shipped to you, you will note shorting bars or bridges,  
one connecting the two red input terminals and the other  
connecting the two black input terminals. Remove these  
shorting bars or bridges only if you plan to bi-amplify  
your speakers.  
Bi-amplification connection  
To make the bi-amplification connections, use the FRONT  
and SURROUND BACK terminals as shown below. To  
activate the bi-amplification connections, set “BI-AMP”  
to “ON” in “ADVANCED SETUP” (see page 136).  
This unit  
SURROUND BACK/  
+
+
+
+
BI-AMP  
SINGLE  
Conventional connection  
If you want to connect your speakers as traditional  
loudspeakers using the conventional connection method,  
connect your speakers using the regular left and right  
speaker wire connections and ignore the second set of  
terminals.  
FRONT  
L
R
This unit  
+
FRONT  
+
L
R
Left  
Right  
Front speakers  
Note  
Remove the shorting bars or bridges to separate the LPF (low  
pass filter) and HPF (high pass filter) crossovers.  
Right  
Left  
Front speakers  
Shorting bars  
or bridges  
Shorting bars  
or bridges  
19 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Information on jacks and cable plugs  
Audio jacks and cable plugs  
Video jacks and cable plugs  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
Y
PB  
PR  
L
R
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
(White)  
(Red)  
(Orange)  
(Yellow)  
(Green) (Blue) (Red)  
S
O
V
PB  
PR  
Y
L
R
C
Left and right  
analog audio digital audio  
cable plugs  
Coaxial  
Optical  
digital  
audio cable  
plug  
Composite  
video cable  
plug  
S-video  
cable plug  
Component  
video cable  
plugs  
cable plug  
Audio jacks  
Video jacks  
This unit has three types of audio jacks. Connection  
depends on the availability of audio jacks on your other  
components.  
This unit has three types of video jacks. Connection  
depends on the availability of input jacks on your video  
monitor.  
AUDIO jacks  
VIDEO jacks  
For conventional analog audio signals transmitted via left  
and right analog audio cables. Connect red plugs to the  
right jacks and white plugs to the left jacks.  
For conventional composite video signals transmitted via  
composite video cables.  
S VIDEO jacks  
DIGITAL COAXIAL jacks  
For digital audio signals transmitted via coaxial digital  
audio cables.  
For S-video signals, separated into the luminance (Y) and  
chrominance (C) video signals transmitted on separate  
wires of S-video cables.  
DIGITAL OPTICAL jacks  
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks  
For digital audio signals transmitted via optical digital  
audio cables.  
For component video signals, separated into the  
luminance (Y) and chrominance (PB, PR) video signals  
transmitted on separate wires of component video cables.  
Note  
y
You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and  
DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both the  
COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the signals  
input at the COAXIAL jack. All digital input jacks are  
compatible with 96-kHz sampling digital signals.  
This unit equips the video conversion function. See pages 22 and  
102 for details.  
20 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Information on HDMI  
This unit has the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2, HDMI IN 3 and HDMI OUT jacks for digital audio and video signal input/  
output. Connect the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN 3 jack of this unit to the HDMI output jack of other HDMI  
components (such as a DVD player). Connect the HDMI OUT jack of this unit to the HDMI IN jack of other HDMI  
components (such as a TV and a projector).  
The video or audio signals input at the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN 3 jack of the selected input source are  
output at the HDMI OUT jack of this unit.  
Note  
You can check the potential problem about the HDMI connection (see page 117).  
HDMI compatibility with this unit  
HDMI jack and cable plug  
Compatible  
HDMI  
components  
HDMI  
Audio signal  
types  
Audio signal  
formats  
2ch Linear  
PCM  
2ch, 32-192 kHz,  
16/20/24 bit  
CD, DVD-Video,  
DVD-Audio, etc.  
Multi-ch  
Linear PCM  
8ch, 32-192 kHz,  
16/20/24 bit  
DVD-Audio, etc.  
DSD  
2/5.1ch,  
SACD, etc.  
2.8224 MHz, 1 bit  
Bitstream  
Dolby Digital,  
DTS  
DVD-Video, etc.  
HDMI cable plug  
This unit’s HDMI interface is based on the following  
standards:  
y
• We recommend using an HDMI cable shorter than 5 meters (16  
feet) with the HDMI logo printed on it.  
• Use a conversion cable (HDMI jack DVI-D jack) to connect  
this unit to other DVI components.  
HDMI Version 1.2a (High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface Specification Version 1.2a) licensed by  
HDMI Licensing, LLC.  
HDCP Revision 1.1 (High-bandwidth Digital  
Content Protection System Revision 1.1) licensed  
by Digital Content Protection, LLC.  
Notes  
• Do not disconnect or connect the cable or turn off the power of  
the HDMI components connected to the HDMI OUT jack of  
this unit while data is being transferred. Doing so may disrupt  
playback or cause noise.  
• Audio signals input at input jacks other than the HDMI IN 1,  
HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN 3 of this unit cannot be digitally  
output at the HDMI OUT jack.  
Notes  
• When CPPM copy-protected DVD audio is played back, video  
and audio signals may not be output depending on the type of  
the DVD player.  
• This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or  
DVI components.  
• If you turn off the power of the video monitor connected to the  
HDMI OUT jack via a DVI connection, this unit may fail to  
establish the connection to the component.  
• The analog video signals input at the composite video, S-video  
and component video jacks can be digitally up-converted to be  
output at the HDMI OUT jack. Set “Conversion” to “On” in  
“Video” (see page 102) to activate this feature.  
21 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Audio and video signal flow  
Audio signal flow  
Video signal flow  
Input  
Output  
Input  
Output  
HDMI  
HDMI  
DIGITAL AUDIO  
(COAXIAL)  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
DIGITAL AUDIO  
(OPTICAL)  
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
Digital output  
Analog output  
Through  
Video conversion (see page 102)  
Notes  
Component interlace/progressive  
up-conversion (see page 102)  
• 2-channel as well as multi-channel PCM, Dolby Digital and  
DTS signals input at the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN  
3 jack can be output at the HDMI OUT jack only when  
“Support Audio” is set to “Other” (see page 115).  
HDMI interlace/progressive  
up-conversion and resolution up-  
• Audio signals input at the HDMI IN jacks are not output at the  
analog AUDIO OUT and DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks.  
Notes  
• When the analog video signals are input at the COMPONENT  
VIDEO, S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks, the priority order of the  
input signals is as follows:  
1. COMPONENT VIDEO  
2. S VIDEO  
3. VIDEO  
• The analog video signals output at the COMPONENT VIDEO  
jacks can be deinterlaced from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) to  
480p/576p. Set “Component I/P” to “On” in “Video” to activate  
• Digital video signals input at the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or HDMI IN  
3 jack cannot be output to analog video output jacks.  
• The analog component video signals with 480i (NTSC)/576i  
(PAL) of resolution are converted to the s-video or composite  
video signals and output at the S VIDEO MONITOR OUT and  
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.  
• Component interlace/progressive conversion (see page 102) and  
HDMI up-scaling (see page 102) are available only when  
“Conversion” is set to “On” (see page 102).  
• Use the “HDMI Up-Scaling” parameter in “Video” to  
deinterlace and convert the resolution of the analog video  
signals output at the HDMI OUT jack (see page 102).  
• The GUI screen signal is not output at the VCR 1 OUT and  
DVR/VCR 2 OUT jacks and is not recorded.  
22 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a TV monitor or projector  
Connect your TV (or projector) to the HDMI OUT jack, the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks, the S  
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack or the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit.  
CAUTION  
Do not connect this unit or other components to the AC power supply until all connections between  
components are complete.  
y
You can select to play back HDMI audio signals on this unit or on another HDMI component connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the  
rear panel of this unit. Use the “Support Audio” parameter in “Option” to select the component to play back HDMI audio signals (see  
Notes  
• Some video monitors connected to this unit via a DVI connection fail to recognize the HDMI audio/video signals being input if they  
are in the standby mode. In this case, the HDMI indicator flashes irregularly.  
• Set “Conversion” in “Video” to “On” (see page 102) to display the short message displays.  
• Set “Wall Paper” in “Video” to “Yes” or “Gray” (see page 104) to display the parameter displays.  
• The GUI screen appears with the wall paper or gray background depending on the input video signal format and the setting of the  
parameters in “Wall Paper” (see page 104).  
COMPONENTVIDEO  
MONITOR OUT  
MONITOR OUT  
Y
SVIDEO  
VIDEO  
PB  
HDMI  
PR  
OUT  
(U.S.A. model)  
S
V
Y
PB  
PR  
Component video in  
HDMI in  
Video in  
S-video in  
TV  
(or projector)  
indicates recommended connections  
indicates alternative connections  
23 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting other components  
CAUTION  
Do not connect this unit or other components to the AC power supply until all connections between  
components are complete.  
Notes  
• When “Conversion” is set to “Off” (see page 102), be sure to make the same type of video connections as those made for your TV (see  
page 23). For example, if you connected your TV to the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit, connect your other components to  
the VIDEO jacks.  
• When “Conversion” is set to “On” (see page 102), the converted video signals are output only at the MONITOR OUT jacks. When  
recording a source, you must make the same type of video connections between each component.  
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the default component assigned to each DIGITAL INPUT or DIGITAL  
OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for “Option”, “Optical Output”, or “Coaxial Input” in “I/O Assignment” (see  
• If you connect your DVD player to both the DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jacks, priority is  
given to the signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
• The short message display does not appear when the component video signals with 720p, 1080i or 1080p resolutions are input.  
• The short message display does not appear when the component video signals with 480p/576p resolutions are input and output at the  
VIDEO or S VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack.  
Connecting a DVD player  
DVD player  
HDMI out  
Optical out  
Audio out  
Coaxial out  
Component out  
S-video out  
Video out  
C
R
L
PR  
PB  
Y
V
O
S
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
DVD  
DVD  
A
Y
P
B
HDMI  
PR  
L
R
IN1  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
DVD  
OPTICAL  
DVD  
5
DVD  
2
(U.S.A. model)  
indicates recommended connections  
indicates alternative connections  
24 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a DVD recorder, PVR or VCR  
Note  
*1 When you connect another VCR to this unit, connect it to the VCR 1 terminals (S VIDEO IN, VIDEO IN, AUDIO IN, S VIDEO  
OUT, VIDEO OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks) same as DVR/VCR 2 terminals except the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
*1  
VIDEO  
IN  
VCR 1  
OUT IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT  
L
R
IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
DVR/  
3
VCR2  
(U.S.A. model)  
S
S
V
V
L
R
R
L
C
DVD recorder, PVR or VCR  
Connecting set-top boxes  
Satellite receiver,  
cable TV receiver  
HDTV decoder  
HDMI out  
Component out  
Optical out  
R
L
L
R
PR  
PB  
Y
V
S
V
PR  
PB  
Y
O
O
S
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
CBL/SAT  
DTV  
Y
P
B
HDMI  
IN3  
PR  
L
R
CBL/  
SAT  
IN2  
DTV  
DIGITAL INPUT  
OPTICAL  
CBL/  
SAT  
DTV  
6
7
(U.S.A. model)  
25 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting audio components  
Notes  
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the default component assigned to either the DIGITAL INPUT jack or the  
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for “Option”, “Optical Output”, or “Coaxial Input” in “I/O Assignment”  
• Connect your turntable to the GND terminal of this unit to reduce noise in the signal. However, you may hear less noise without the  
connection to the GND terminal for some turntables.  
• The PHONO jacks are only compatible with a turntable with an MM or a high-output MC cartridge. To connect a turntable with a low-  
output MC cartridge to the PHONO jacks, use an in-line boosting transformer or an MC-head amplifier.  
• When you connect both the DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) jack and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack to an audio component,  
the priority is given to the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
Audio out  
Audio in  
Optical in  
L
O
R
L
CD recorder  
R
IN  
(PLAY)  
OUT  
(REC)  
MD/  
L
R
TAPE  
GND  
PHONO  
CD  
CD-R  
L
R
IN(PLAY)  
AUDIO  
OUT(REC)  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
MD/  
TAPE  
CD  
CD  
CD-R  
1
4
8
9
(U.S.A. model)  
O
O
R
L
R
L
C
R
L
R
L
Coaxial  
out  
Ground  
Optical  
out  
Audio out  
Audio  
out  
Audio  
in  
Audio  
out  
Optical in  
CD player  
MD recorder or  
tape deck  
Turntable  
26 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting an external amplifier  
This unit has more than enough power for any home use.  
However, if you want to add more power to the speaker  
output or if you want to use another amplifier, connect an  
external amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks.  
Notes  
• When you make connections to the PRE OUT jacks, do not  
make connections to the SPEAKERS terminals.  
• The signals output at the FRONT PRE OUT and CENTER PRE  
OUT jacks are affected by the TONE CONTROL settings (see  
page 52).  
• Each PRE OUT jack outputs the same channel signals as the  
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.  
• Adjust the volume level of the subwoofer with the control on  
the subwoofer (see page 53).  
• Some signals may not be output at the SUBWOOFER PRE  
OUT jack depending on the settings for “Speaker Set” (see  
page 105) and “Bass Out” (see page 107).  
1
2
3
4
CENTER  
FRONT  
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
L
R
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
SUB  
WOOFER  
PRE OUT  
5
1 CENTER PRE OUT jack  
Center channel output jack.  
2 FRONT PRE OUT jacks  
Front channel output jacks.  
3 SURROUND PRE OUT jacks  
Surround channel output jacks.  
4 SURROUND BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT  
jacks  
Surround back or presence channel output jacks. When  
you only connect one external amplifier for the surround  
back channel, connect it to the SINGLE (SB) jack.  
y
• Set the “Surround Back” to “Large x2”, “Large x1”, “Small x2”  
or “Small x1” and “Presence” to “None” (see page 106) to  
output the surround back channel signals at SURROUND  
BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT jacks.  
• Set the “Presence” to “Yes” and “Surround Back” to “None”  
(see page 106) to output the presence channel signals at  
SURROUND BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT jacks.  
5 SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jack  
Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier.  
27 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder  
This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right FRONT, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and  
SUBWOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from a multi-format player, external decoder, sound processor or  
pre-amplifier.  
If you set “Input Channels” to “8ch” in “MULTI CH” (see page 97), you can use the input jacks assigned as “Front  
Input” in “Multi CH Assign” (see page 97) together with the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to input 8-channel signals.  
Connect the output jacks on your multi-format player or external decoder to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to  
match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the front and surround channels.  
Notes  
• When you select the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks as the input source (see page 43), this unit automatically  
turns off the digital sound field processor, and you cannot select sound field programs.  
• This unit does not redirect signals input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers. We recommend that  
you connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system before using this feature.  
For 6-channel input  
For 8-channel input  
(REC)  
(PLAY)  
FRONT(6CH)  
CENTER  
SURROUND  
MD/  
TAPE  
L
L
UT  
*1  
R
R
FRONT(6CH)  
CENTER  
CENTER  
SURROUND  
SUB  
WOOFER  
SB(8CH)  
L
MULTI CH INPUT  
R
L
R
L
R
SUB  
SUB  
WOOFER  
WOOFER  
SB(8CH)  
MULTI CH INPUT  
L
R
L
R
L
R
Multi-format player/  
External decoder  
Multi-format player/  
External decoder  
Note  
*1 The analog audio input jacks assigned as “Front Input” in  
“Multi CH Assign” (see page 97).  
28 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock  
Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the  
front panel  
This unit is equipped with the DOCK terminal on the rear  
panel that allows you to connect a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately)  
where you can station your iPod and control playback of  
your iPod using the supplied remote control. Connect a  
YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold  
separately) to the DOCK terminal on the rear panel of this  
unit using its dedicated cable.  
Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to connect a  
game console or a video camera to this unit.  
CAUTION  
Be sure to turn off the volume of this unit and  
other components before making connections.  
Note  
CAUTION  
The audio signals input at the DOCK terminal on the rear panel  
take priority over the ones input at the VIDEO AUX jacks.  
Do not connect this unit to the AC power supply  
until all connections between components are  
complete.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
VIDEO  
L
OPTICAL  
S VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
DOCK  
S
V
O
L
R
YAMAHA iPod universal dock  
(such as the YDS-10,  
sold separately)  
S-Video  
output  
Video Audio Optical  
output output output  
Game console or  
video camera  
29 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the network  
To connect this unit to your network, plug one end of a network cable (CAT-5 or higher straight cable) into the  
NETWORK port of this unit, and plug the other end into one of the LAN ports on your router that supports the DHCP  
(Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) server function. The following diagram shows a connection example where this  
unit is connected to one of the LAN ports on a 4-port router. To enjoy music files saved on your PC and YAMAHA  
MCX-2000 or access the Internet Radio, each device must be connected properly in the network.  
Note  
If the DHCP server function on your router is disabled, you need to configure the network settings manually (see page 109).  
YAMAHA MCX-2000  
YAMAHA MCX-C15  
Internet  
WAN  
LAN  
YAMAHA MCX-A10  
(with optional  
speakers)  
PC  
Modem  
Router  
Network cable  
NETWORK  
30 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the FM and AM antennas  
Both FM and AM indoor antennas are supplied with this  
unit. Connect each antenna correctly to the designated  
terminals. In general, these antennas should provide  
sufficient signal strength.  
2
3
Press and hold the tab of the AM ANT  
terminal.  
Notes  
• Be sure to set the tuner frequency step (Asia and General  
models only) according to the frequency spacing in your area  
• The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit.  
• The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an  
outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit.  
• A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception  
than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality,  
install an outdoor antenna. Consult the nearest authorized  
YAMAHA dealer or service center about outdoor antennas.  
Insert one of the AM loop antenna lead wires  
into the AM ANT terminal.  
Indoor FM  
AM loop  
antenna  
(supplied)  
antenna  
(supplied)  
ANTENNA  
GND AM  
FM  
4
5
Release the tab of the AM ANT terminal.  
(U.S.A. model)  
Outdoor AM antenna  
Use a 5 to 10 m (16.4 to 32.8  
ft) vinyl-covered wire  
extended outdoors from a  
window.  
Ground (GND terminal)  
Repeat steps 2 through 4 to connect the  
other lead wire to the GND terminal.  
For maximum safety and minimum interference, connect the  
antenna GND terminal to a good earth ground. A good earth  
ground is a metal stake driven into moist earth.  
y
Once you have properly connected the AM loop antenna to  
this unit, orient the AM loop antenna for the best reception  
when you tune into AM stations (see page 56).  
Connecting the AM loop antenna  
1
Set up the AM loop antenna.  
31 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the power cable  
Connecting the AC power cable  
CAUTION  
Use the supplied AC cable. Do not use other AC power cables as doing so may result in fire or  
electrical shock.  
Plug the supplied AC power cable into the AC inlet after all other connections are complete, then plug the AC power  
cable into an AC wall outlet.  
(U.S.A. model)  
AC IN  
To the AC wall outlet  
AC OUTLETS  
VOLTAGE SELECTOR  
AC OUTLET(S) (SWITCHED)  
U.K. and Australia models..................................... 1 outlet  
Korea model............................................................... None  
Other models......................................................... 2 outlets  
(Asia and General models only)  
CAUTION  
Use these outlet(s) to supply power to any connected  
components. Connect the power cable of your other  
components to these outlet(s). Power to these outlet(s) is  
supplied when this unit is turned on. However, power to  
these outlet(s) is cut off when this unit is turned off. For  
information on the maximum power or the total power  
consumption of the components that can be connected to  
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of  
this unit must be set for your local voltage  
BEFORE plugging the power cable into the AC  
wall outlet. Improper setting of the VOLTAGE  
SELECTOR may cause damage to this unit and  
create a potential fire hazard.  
Rotate the VOLTAGE SELECTOR clockwise or  
counterclockwise to the correct position using a  
straight slot screwdriver.  
Voltages are as follows:  
..............................110/120/220/230–240 V AC, 50/60 Hz  
Memory back-up  
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data  
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.  
However, the stored data will be lost in case the power  
cable is disconnected from the AC wall outlet or if the  
power supply is cut off for more than one week.  
VOLTAGE  
SELECTOR  
230-  
Voltage indication  
240V  
32 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
CONNECTIONS  
Setting the speaker impedance  
CAUTION  
4
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to select “6MIN”.  
The following display appears in the front panel  
display.  
If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, set “SPEAKER  
IMP.” to “6MIN” as follows BEFORE using this  
unit. 4 ohm speakers can be also used as the  
front speakers.  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
SPEAKER IMP.  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
6
MIN  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
5
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to save  
the new setting and turn off this unit.  
2,5  
3
2,4  
1
2
Make sure this unit is turned off.  
See page 34 for details about turning on or off this  
unit.  
MASTER  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
Note  
The setting you made is reflected next time you turn on this  
unit.  
While holding  
down  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select “SPEAKER IMP.”.  
The following display appears in the front panel  
display.  
PROGRAM  
SPEAKER IMP.  
8
MIN  
33 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CONNECTIONS  
Turning on and off the power  
When all connections are complete, turn on this unit.  
MAIN ZONE ON/OFF  
(U.S.A. model)  
(U.S.A. model)  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
PURE DIRECT  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
VOLUME  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
MASTER ON/OFF  
Turning on this unit  
Turning on the main zone from the  
standby mode  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel  
inward to the ON position to turn on this  
unit.  
When you turns on this unit by pressing MASTER ON/  
OFF, the main zone is turned on.  
Press MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front  
panel (or POWER on the remote control) to  
turn on the main zone.  
MAIN ZONE  
POWER  
or  
ON/OFF  
MASTER  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Front panel  
Turning off this unit  
Set the main zone to the standby mode  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel  
again to release it outward to the OFF  
position to turn off this unit.  
Press MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front  
panel (or STANDBY on the remote control)  
to set the main zone to the standby mode.  
MAIN ZONE  
STANDBY  
MASTER  
or  
ON/OFF  
Front panel  
Notes  
Front panel  
Remote control  
• MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front panel as well as POWER  
and STANDBY on the remote control are operational only  
when MASTER ON/OFF is pressed inward to the ON position.  
• As usual, we recommend using the standby mode to turn off this  
unit.  
34 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AUTO SETUP  
AUTO SETUP  
This unit employs the YPAO (YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) technology which lets you avoid  
troublesome listening-based speaker setup and achieves highly accurate sound adjustments automatically. The supplied  
optimizer microphone collects and this unit analyzes the sound your speakers produce in your actual listening  
environment.  
Using Auto Setup  
Once you have connected the supplied optimizer  
microphone to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel and have placed it in a suitable location in your  
listening room, run “Auto Setup” in the GUI screen.  
1
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
(U.S.A. model)  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
FM/AM  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
Notes  
EDIT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MULTI ZONE  
• Connect a video monitor to run “Auto Setup” (see page 23).  
• Be advised that it is normal for loud test tones to be output  
during the “Auto Setup” procedure.  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
• To achieve the best results, make sure the room is as quiet as  
possible while the “Auto Setup” procedure is in progress. If  
there is too much ambient noise, the results may not be  
satisfactory.  
Omni-directional  
microphone  
y
• If an error occurs during the “Auto Setup” procedure and an  
error or warning message appears in the GUI screen or in the  
front panel display, see the “Auto Setup” section in  
list of error and warning messages and proper remedies.  
• The initial setting for each parameter is indicated in bold.  
• If the volume level and the crossover frequency of your  
subwoofer can be adjusted, set the volume level to about half  
way (or slightly less) and set the crossover frequency to the  
maximum.  
2
Place the optimizer microphone at your  
normal listening position on a flat level  
surface with the omni-directional  
microphone heading upward.  
Optimizer microphone  
AMP  
4
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
4,13  
5-12  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
y
It is recommended that you use a tripod (etc.) to affix the  
optimizer microphone at the same height as your ears would be  
when you are seated in your listening position. You can use a 6  
mm diameter screw to fix the optimizer microphone to a tripod  
(etc.).  
35 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AUTO SETUP  
3
Make sure of the following check points  
6
7
Press hto enter “Setup Menu”.  
before starting the Auto Setup operations.  
• Speakers are connected appropriately.  
• Supplied optimizer microphone is connected to this  
unit and placed appropriately.  
• Headphones are disconnected from this unit.  
• The room is sufficiently quiet.  
Skip  
Check  
Wiring  
Distance  
Size  
• The video monitor connected to this unit is turned on.  
4
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU to turn on the GUI  
screen.  
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select “Wiring”,  
“Distance”, “Size”, “Equalizing”, or “Level”,  
and then press hto set the selected  
parameter.  
The GUI screen appears on the video monitor.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
ENTER  
ENTER  
Sound  
Video  
A/B/C/D/E  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
A/B/C/D/E  
Currently  
selected menu  
item  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
8
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select the desired  
parameter and then ENTER to confirm the  
selection.  
System Memory  
\
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
5
Press k/ nrepeatedly and then hto select  
“Auto Setup”.  
“Setup Menu” is selected as the currently selected  
menu item.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Input Select  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Information  
Setup Menu  
Start  
System Memory  
Signal Info.  
Information  
Setup Menu  
Start  
Wiring  
Distance  
Size  
36 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AUTO SETUP  
Equalizing (Parametric equalizer level)  
Adjusts the frequency and the parametric equalizer  
level of each channel to reduce coloration across the  
channels and create a cohesive sound field. This is  
particularly important if you use different brands or  
sizes of speakers for some channels or have a room  
with unique sonic characteristics. In addition, the  
frequency response of each channel is adjusted in  
accordance with the sound output from your front  
speakers.  
9
Repeat steps 7 and 8 until you set all the  
desired parameters.  
Skip  
Wiring  
Distance  
Size  
Check  
Choices: Check:Natural, Check:Flat, Check:Front,  
Skip  
Wiring  
Skip  
Distance  
Size  
Check  
• Select “Check:Natural” to average out the  
frequency response of all speakers with higher  
frequencies being less emphasized. Recommended  
if the “Check:Flat” setting sounds a little harsh.  
• Select “Check:Flat” to average the frequency  
response of all speakers. Recommended if all of  
your speakers are of similar quality.  
Equalizing  
Wiring  
Distance  
Size  
Skip  
Check  
Equalizing  
Level  
• Select “Check:Front” to adjust the frequency  
response of each speaker in accordance with the  
sound of your front speakers. Recommended if  
your front speakers are of much higher quality than  
your other speakers.  
Distance  
Size  
Skip  
Equalizing  
Level  
Check: Natural  
Check: Flat  
Check: Front  
• Select “Skip” to skip the selected item and perform  
no adjustments.  
Size  
Level (Volume level)  
Checks and adjusts the volume level of each speaker.  
Equalizing  
Level  
Skip  
Check  
Choices: Check, Skip  
• Select “Check” to automatically check and adjust  
this item.  
This unit performs the following checks:  
• Select “Skip” to skip this item and perform no  
adjustments.  
Wiring (Speaker wiring)  
Checks which speakers are connected and the  
polarity of each speaker.  
10 Once you have selected the desired settings  
of each parameter, press lto return to the  
previous menu level and then press nto  
select “Start”.  
Distance (Speaker distance)  
Checks the distance of each speaker from the  
listening position and adjusts the timing of each  
channel.  
Information  
Setup Menu  
Size (Speaker size)  
Checks the frequency response of each speaker and  
sets the appropriate low-frequency crossover for each  
channel.  
Start  
Start: ENTER  
Choices: Check, Skip  
• Select “Check” to automatically check and adjust  
the item.  
• Select “Skip” to skip the item and perform no  
adjustments.  
37 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
y
If you are not satisfied with the results or want to manually  
adjust each parameter, set the parameters in “Basic” (see  
11 Press ENTER to start the setup procedure.  
This unit starts the auto setup procedure. Loud test  
tones are output from each speaker during the auto  
setup procedure. During the setup procedure,  
“Measuring...” appears in the GUI screen. We  
recommend getting out of the room while thus unit is  
in the auto setup procedure. The necessary time for  
the auto setup procedure depends on the environment  
of the listening room and connected speaker (from 30  
seconds to 3 minutes).  
Notes  
• If you change speakers, speaker positions, or the layout of  
your listening environment, run “Auto Setup” again to  
recalibrate your system.  
• The distances displayed in the “Distance” results may be  
longer than the actual distance depending on the  
characteristics of your subwoofer.  
• In the “Equalizing” results, different values may be set for  
the same band to provide finer adjustments.  
PRESET/CH  
13 Press SET MENU to exit from the GUI screen.  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
y
Notes  
• To stop the Auto Setup procedure and set this unit to the  
• After you have completed the “Auto Setup” procedure, be  
sure to disconnect the optimizer microphone.  
• The optimizer microphone is sensitive to heat. Keep it  
away from direct sunlight and do not place it on top of this  
unit.  
pause mode, press one of the cursor buttons (k/ n/ l/  
h) or ENTER. In the pause mode, press kto retry the  
procedure, and lto cancel the Auto Setup procedure.  
• If an error message appears and this unit stops the setup  
out the remedy, retry the Auto Setup procedure.  
Reviewing the result of the auto setup  
Use this feature to review the result of the auto setup.  
12 Once all items are set successfully, following  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU to turn on the GUI  
screen.  
display appears in the GUI screen.  
Retry  
Detail  
Setup  
Equalizing  
Level  
AMP  
Exit  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
Result  
SRCH MODE  
Measurement Over  
Successfully  
TV  
Sound  
Video  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
• Press nand select “Setup” to set the measured  
values.  
• Press kand select “Retry” to retry the Auto Setup  
procedure.  
• Press hand select “Detail” to view information  
about measurement results and warning messages.  
For more details about warning messages, see the  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
System Memory  
• Press land select “Exit” to exit from the Auto  
Setup procedure. If you select “Exit”, “Don’t  
Setup?” appears on the screen. To set the measured  
values and exit, select “Yes”. To cancel the settings  
and exit, select “No”.  
38 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AUTO SETUP  
Wiring (Speaker wiring)  
2
3
4
Press k/ nrepeatedly and then hto select  
“Auto Setup”.  
Displays the polarity of each connected speaker.  
• “NRM” appears when the polarity of the connected  
speaker is normal.  
• “REV” appears when the polarity of the connected  
speaker is reversed.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
Note  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
“---” appears when no speaker is connected to the  
corresponding speaker channel.  
Distance (Speaker distance)  
Displays the speaker distance from the listening  
position. Press l/ hto switch the unit to display the  
value of the each speaker distance.  
Press kto select “Information”.  
Note  
Information  
Setup Menu  
Start  
Wiring  
Distance  
Size  
“---” appears when no speaker is connected to the  
corresponding speaker channel.  
Size (Speaker size)  
Displays the size of the connected speakers. The bass  
cross over frequency (“Cross”) appears at the bottom  
of the menu area.  
• “LRG” appears when the connected speaker has  
the ability to reproduce the low-frequency signals  
effectively.  
Press hand then nrepeatedly to select the  
desired check items.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
• “SML” appears when the connected speaker does  
not have the ability to reproduce the low-frequency  
signals effectively.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Note  
“---” appears when no speaker is connected to the  
corresponding speaker channel.  
Left  
Right  
Front  
Center  
Sur.  
S.Back NRM  
PRNS  
NRM  
NRM  
NRM  
NRM  
Equalizing (Speaker equalizing)  
Displays the result of the adjustment of the frequency  
responses of each connected speaker.  
NRM  
NRM  
NRM  
Wiring  
NRM  
NRM  
Reload:ENTER  
Distance  
Size  
SubWfr  
Note  
Gray line appears when no speaker is connected to the  
corresponding speaker channel.  
Level (speaker level)  
Displays the speaker output level of the connected  
speakers.  
Note  
Gray line appears when no speaker is connected to the  
corresponding speaker channel.  
39 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
PLAYBACK  
CAUTION  
Extreme caution should be exercised when you play back CDs encoded in DTS. If you play back a CD  
encoded in DTS on a DTS-incompatible CD player, you will only hear some unwanted noise that may  
damage your speakers. Check whether your CD player supports CDs encoded in DTS. Also, check the  
sound output level of your CD player before you play back a CD encoded in DTS.  
y
To play DTS-encoded CDs when using a digital audio connection, set “Decoder Mode” in “Input Select” to “DTS” before the playback  
Basic procedure  
2
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to AMP  
and then press one of the input selector  
buttons on the remote control) to select the  
desired input source.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
INPUT  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
Front panel  
or  
2
5
4
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
POWER  
POWER  
AV  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
STANDBY  
POWER  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
NET/USB  
TV  
SRCH MODE  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
2
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
5
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
SELECT  
9
0
+
Remote control  
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
2
4
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
The name of the currently selected input source  
appears in the front panel display and in the short  
message display for a few seconds.  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
(U.S.A. model)  
Available input sources  
NET/USB V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
1
Turn on the video monitor connected to this  
unit.  
INPUT: DVD  
y
Currently selected input source  
You can control this unit by using the graphical user  
interface (GUI) screen. See page 44 for details.  
You can turn on or off the short message displays on the  
video monitor. See page 103 for details.  
Note  
For details about controlling XM Satellite Radio when  
“XM” is selected as the input source, see page 67.  
40 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PLAYBACK  
Note  
3
4
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
• Refer to the operating instructions for the source  
component.  
See page 56 for details about tuning instructions.  
See page 67 for details about XM Satellite Radio  
tuning instructions.  
Sound field programs and the Compressed Music Enhancer  
mode cannot be selected when the component connected to  
the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input source  
(see page 43) and Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG” (see page 42).  
y
• Choose a sound field program based on your listening  
preference, not merely on the name of the program.  
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically  
selects the last sound field program used with the  
corresponding input source.  
Rotate VOLUME on the front panel (or press  
VOLUME +/– on the remote control) to adjust  
the volume to the desired output level.  
VOLUME  
Guide to contents  
+
or  
See  
VOLUME  
When you want to...  
page  
Enjoy pure hi-fi stereo sound  
Adjust the tonal quality of the front speakers  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Enjoy the compressed music sources in enhanced  
sound  
Edit parameters of sound field programs  
y
See page 53 to adjust the level of each speaker.  
Enjoy the sources which have wide dynamic range at  
night  
5
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel (or press one of the sound field  
program selector buttons on the remote  
control repeatedly) to select the desired  
sound field program.  
Use headphones  
Enjoy multi-channel sources in 2-channel stereo  
Select a decoder to play back sources with  
Set this unit to the standby mode automatically  
The name of the selected sound field program appears  
in the front panel display and in the short message  
display. See page 47 for details about sound field  
programs.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
or  
STEREO  
5
PROGRAM  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Currently selected sound field program category  
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
Currently selected sound field program  
41 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
PLAYBACK  
AUTO  
HDMI  
Automatically selects input signals in  
the following order:  
(1)HDMI  
(2)Digital signals  
(3)Analog signals  
Selects only HDMI signals. When  
HDMI signals are not input, no sound  
is output.  
Selecting audio input jacks  
(AUDIO SELECT)  
This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. Use this  
feature (Audio input jack select) to switch the input jack  
assigned to an input source when more than one jacks are  
assigned to an input source.  
COAX/OPT Automatically selects input signals in  
the following order:  
y
• We recommend setting Audio input jack select to “AUTO” in  
most cases.  
You can adjust the default Audio input jack select of this unit by  
using “Audio Select” in “Option” (see page 114).  
You can also set Audio input jack select setting in “Audio  
Select” in “Input Select” (see page 96).  
(1)Digital signals input at the  
COAXIAL jack.  
(2)Digital signals input at the  
OPTICAL jack.  
When no signals are input, no sound is  
output.  
ANALOG  
Selects only analog signals. If no  
analog signals are input, no sound is  
output.  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control) to select the desired  
input source.  
Note  
INPUT  
This feature is not available when no digital input jack  
(OPTICAL, COAXIAL and HDMI) are assigned. Use “I/O  
Assignment” in “Input Select” to reassign the respective  
input jack (see page 96).  
PHONO  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
or  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
Front panel  
Remote control  
2
Press AUDIO SELECT on the front panel (or  
AUDIO SEL on the remote control) repeatedly  
to select the desired Audio input jack select  
setting.  
AUDIO  
AUDIO SEL  
SELECT  
or  
Available input sources  
NET/USB V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
A.SEL: AUTO  
Currently selected  
Audio input jack  
select setting  
42 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PLAYBACK  
Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT  
component  
Use this feature to select the component connected to the  
MULTI CH INPUT jacks (see page 28) as the input  
source.  
Using your headphones  
Connect a pair of headphones with a stereo  
analog audio cable plug to the PHONES jack on  
the front panel.  
Rotate the input selector on the front panel to  
select MULTI CH INPUT (or MULTI CH IN on the  
remote control).  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
TUNING  
MODE  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
INPUT  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
MULTI CH IN  
or  
Front panel  
Remote control  
y
y
Use “MULTI CH” menu in “Input Select” to set the parameters  
When you select a sound field program, SILENT CINEMA mode  
for MULTI CH INPUT (see page 97).  
activates automatically (see page 51).  
Note  
Notes  
Sound field programs and the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
cannot be selected when the component connected to the MULTI  
CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input source (see page 46) and  
Audio input jack select is set to “ANALOG” (see page 42).  
• When you connect headphones, no signals are output at the  
speaker terminals.  
• When headphones are used, only front L/R channel signals are  
output.  
• All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals are mixed down to the  
left and right headphone channels.  
Muting the audio output  
Press MUTE on the remote control to mute the  
audio output. Press MUTE again to resume the  
audio output.  
MUTE  
y
You can also rotate VOLUME on the front panel or press  
VOLUME +/– on the remote control to resume the audio  
output.  
You can adjust the muting level by using the “Muting Type”  
parameter in “Sound” (see page 100).  
• The MUTE indicator flashes in the front panel display when the  
audio output is muted and disappears from the front panel  
display when the audio output is resumed.  
43 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
PLAYBACK  
Operating the amplifier functions of this unit by using the graphical user  
interface (GUI) screen  
This unit features a sophisticated graphical user interface (GUI) screen that helps you to control the amplifier function of  
this unit. With the GUI screen, you can view the information of the signals being input and the status of this unit. You can  
also set up this unit using the GUI screen (see page 87).  
Items in GUI screen  
Currently selected  
decoder  
Currently selected  
Currently selected  
sound field program  
Pro Logic  
Sci-Fi  
DVD  
input source  
Sound  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
Video  
Currently selected  
menu item  
Menu area  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
System Memory  
Manual Setup  
-40.0dB  
Volume level  
Current menu directory  
y
• Set the operation mode selector to AMP when you operate this unit by using GUI screen.  
See page 87 for details about the contents in the menu area.  
• This unit reserves the previously selected GUI screen.  
Basic controls in the GUI screen  
1 ENTER  
AMP  
Press to select the currently selected menu item and move  
to the next menu level.  
+
VOLUME  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
SOURCE  
TV  
Set to AMP  
2 Cursor l  
Press to return to the previous menu level.  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
1
2
3
3 SET MENU  
Press to display or turn off the GUI screen.  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
SRCH MODE  
4
5
4 Cursor k/ n  
Press to select the item in the current menu level.  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
5 Cursor h  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
Press to select the currently selected menu item and move  
to the next menu level.  
44 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PLAYBACK  
Playing video sources in the  
background of an audio source  
You can combine a video image from a video source with  
sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy  
listening to classical music while viewing beautiful  
scenery from the video source on the video monitor.  
3
Press SLEEP on the remote control  
repeatedly to set the amount of time.  
Each time you press SLEEP, the front panel display  
changes as shown below.  
SLEEP  
Press the input selector buttons on the remote  
control to select a video source and then an  
audio source.  
SLEEP 120min.  
SLEEP 90min.  
SLEEP OFF SLEEP 30min. SLEEP 60min.  
NET/USB  
The SLEEP indicator flashes while you are switching  
the amount of time for the sleep timer. Once the sleep  
timer is set, the SLEEP indicator lights up in the front  
panel display, and the display returns to the selected  
sound field program.  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
Audio sources  
Video sources  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAP
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
SLEEP 120min.  
SLEEP  
y
Set the “BGV” parameter in the “MULTI CH” menu to the  
desired setting to select the default background video input source  
of the MULTI CH INPUT sources (see page 97).  
Flashes  
Using the sleep timer  
STRAIGHT  
Use this feature to automatically set the main zone to the  
standby mode after a certain amount of time. The sleep  
timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit  
is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also  
automatically turns off any external components  
SLEEP  
Analog  
Lights up  
Canceling the sleep timer  
connected to the AC OUTLET(S) (see page 32).  
Press SLEEP on the remote control repeatedly  
until “SLEEP OFF” appears in the front panel  
display.  
1
Press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control to select the desired input  
source.  
SLEEP  
NET/USB  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAP
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
2
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
Refer to the operating instructions for the source  
component.  
SLEEP OFF  
Disappears  
The SLEEP indicator turns off, and “SLEEP OFF”  
disappears from the front panel display after a few  
seconds.  
See page 56 for details about tuning instructions.  
y
The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by pressing  
STANDBY on the remote control (or MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on  
the front panel) to set the main zone to the standby mode.  
45 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
This unit is equipped with a variety of precise digital decoders that allow you to enjoy multi-channel playback from  
almost any stereo or multi-channel sound source. This unit is also equipped with a YAMAHA digital sound field  
processing (DSP) chip containing several sound field programs which you can use to enhance your playback experience.  
y
• When you set the “Decoder Mode” parameter in “Input Select” to “Auto”, this unit selects the appropriate digital decoder according to  
the input signal.  
• The YAMAHA CINEMA DSP modes are compatible with all Dolby Digital, DTS, and Dolby Surround sources.  
• The YAMAHA HiFi DSP sound field programs recreate real-world acoustic environments made from precise measurements taken in  
actual concert halls, music venues, movie theaters, etc. Thus, you may notice variations in the strength of the reflections coming from  
the front, back, left and right.  
You can select sound field programs and adjust the parameters by using the GUI screen. See page 88 for details.  
Selecting sound field programs  
Notes  
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects the last sound field program used with the corresponding input source.  
• Sound field programs cannot be selected when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input  
source (see page 43) and Audio input jack select is set to “ANALOG” (see page 42).  
• When you play back DSD sources with any sound field program, this unit converts the DSD signals to PCM signals and then applies  
the selected program.  
• When you play back DTS 96/24 sources with any sound field program, this unit applies the selected program without activating the  
DTS 96/24 decoder.  
• Sampling frequencies higher than 48 kHz are sampled down to 48 kHz or lower and then sound field programs are applied.  
y
You can select the desired sound field programs and setting the parameters by using GUI screen. see page 88 for details.  
Front panel operations  
Remote control operations  
(U.S.A. model)  
AMP  
AMP  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
PURE DIRECT  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
VOLUME  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
SRCH MODE  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
ENTER  
AUDIO  
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
ON  
OFF  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
MASTER  
Sound field program  
selector buttons  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
PROGRAM selector  
(U.S.A. model)  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press one of the sound field program selector  
buttons on the remote control repeatedly.  
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front panel.  
The name of the selected sound field program appears in  
the front panel display and in the short message display.  
The name of the selected sound field program appears in  
the front panel display and in the short message display.  
46 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
Sound field program descriptions  
y
Select a sound field program based on your listening preference, not merely on the name of the program, etc.  
Created sound  
fields  
CINEMA DSP  
or  
HiFi DSP  
Name of the  
program  
Remote control  
button  
Category of the  
program  
MOVIE  
4
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and expansive  
cinematic space amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and  
DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB. Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
Program description  
Available sound field parameters (see page 89)  
For music audio sources  
y
For audio music sources, we also recommend using the Pure Direct mode (see page 52), the “STRAIGHT” mode (see page 51) or  
surround decode mode (see page 84).  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Munich  
HiFi DSP  
1
This is a large fan-shaped concert hall which has approximately 2500 seats. Almost the whole interior is made of wood. There is relatively  
little reflection from the walls, and sound spreads finely and beautifully.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Vienna  
HiFi DSP  
1
A classic shoe-box type concert hall with approximately 1700 seats. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections which  
produce a very full, rich sound.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Amsterdam  
CLASSICAL  
HiFi DSP  
1
This is a large 2200 seat shoe-box type concert hall in Amsterdam. It has a circular stage with seats located behind the stage.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Church in Freiburg  
HiFi DSP  
1
This program creates the acoustic environment of a big church located in south Germany. The reverberation delay is very long while the early  
reflections are smaller than with other sound field programs.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Liveness  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Delay  
Rev. Level  
Dialogue Lift  
47 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Chamber  
1
HiFi DSP  
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are  
suitable for courtly music and chamber music.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Liveness  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Delay  
Rev. Level  
Dialogue Lift  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Village Vanguard  
HiFi DSP  
2
A traditional jazz club in New York, located on 7th Avenue. This room has a low ceiling, and the “stage” is located at the corner of the room.  
This program creates an intimate “close-to-the music” feel.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Warehouse Loft  
HiFi DSP  
2
This program simulates a space enclosed by concrete. An energetic sound field is created with relatively clear reflections from the walls.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Delay  
Rev. Level  
Dialogue Lift  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Cellar Club  
HiFi DSP  
2
This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field features powerful sound as if the  
listener is in a row in front of a small stage.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
The Roxy Theatre  
HiFi DSP  
2
The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music. The data for this program was recorded at LA’s hottest rock club. The listener’s virtual seat  
is at the center-left of the hall.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Delay  
Rev. Level  
Dialogue Lift  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
The Bottom Line  
2
HiFi DSP  
This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a  
sound field offering real and vibrant sound.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
For various sources  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Sports  
3
This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts,  
the voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned clearly on the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an  
optimum space to offer the listeners with a feeling of presence in the stadium.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
48 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Action Game  
3
This sound field has been optimized for action games such as car racing and FPS games. It uses the reflection data that limits the effects range  
per channel in order to offer a powerful playing environment with a being-there feeling by enhancing various effects tones while maintaining  
a clear sense of directions.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT Roleplaying Game  
3
This sound field has been optimized for role-playing and adventure games. It combines the sound field effects for movies and the sound field  
design used with “Action Game” to represent the depth and 3D feeling of the field during play, while offering movie-like surround effects in  
the movie scenes in the game.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
For visual sources of music  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Music Video  
HiFi DSP  
3  
This sound field offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot  
live space thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to  
the surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Recital/Opera  
3
This program controls the amount of reverberations at an optimum level and emphasizes the depth and clarity of human voices. “Opera”  
offers the reverberations of an orchestra box in front of the listener at the same time as providing the acoustic positioning and feeling of  
presence on the stage. The surround sound field is relatively moderate, but the data for concert hall effects are used to represent the inherent  
beauty of music. The listener will not be fatigued even after long hours of opera entertainment.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
For movie sources  
y
You can select the desired decoder used with following sound field program (except “Mono Movie”). See page 85 for details.  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Standard  
4
This program create a sound field emphasizing the surrounding feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multi-channel  
audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the concept of “an ideal movie theater”, in which the audience is surrounded  
by beautiful reverberations from the left, right and rear.  
DSP Level  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
Sur. Liveness  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
SB Liveness  
Dialogue Lift  
49 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Spectacle  
4
This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a 70-mm movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source sound in detail, making  
both the video and the sound field incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source encoded with Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital or  
DTS (especially large-scale movie productions).  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
4
This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and  
expansive cinematic space amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround,  
Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Adventure  
4
This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films. The sound field is  
made to be similar to that of the newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound field itself are restrained as much as possible.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Drama  
4
This sound field features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The  
reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling, reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear  
words and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after long hours of viewing.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Sur. Init. Delay  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Init. Delay  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Mono Movie  
4
This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources (such as old movies). The program produces the optimum reverberation to  
create sound depth using only the presence sound field.  
DSP Level  
Init. Delay  
Room Size  
Liveness  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Level  
Rev. Delay  
Dialogue Lift  
Stereo playback  
STEREO  
STEREO  
2ch STEREO  
5
Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels. See page 53 for details.  
Direct  
STEREO  
STEREO  
7ch STEREO  
5
HiFi DSP  
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multi-channel sources, this unit downmixes the source to 2  
channels, and then output the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties,  
etc.  
Center Level  
Surround L Level  
Surround R Level  
Sur. Back Level  
Presence L Level  
Presence R Level  
50 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
Using sound field programs without  
surround speakers  
Enjoying unprocessed input  
(Virtual CINEMA DSP)  
sources  
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows you to enjoy the CINEMA  
DSP programs without surround speakers. It creates  
virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field.  
When you set “Surround” to None” (see page 106),  
Virtual CINEMA DSP activates automatically whenever  
you select a CINEMA DSP sound field program (see  
When this unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode, 2-channel  
stereo sources are output from only the front left and right  
speakers. Multi-channel sources are decoded straight into  
the appropriate channels without any additional effect  
processing.  
y
You can also select the “STRAIGHT” mode by using GUI screen.  
See page 88 for details.  
Note  
Virtual CINEMA DSP will not activate even when “Surround” is  
set to “None” (see page 106) in the following cases:  
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks is selected as the input source (see page 43).  
– when headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.  
– when the Pure Direct (see page 52) or “2ch Stereo” mode (see  
page 53) is selected, or when this unit is in the “STRAIGHT”  
mode (see page 51).  
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel (or on the  
remote control) to select “STRAIGHT”.  
STRAIGHT  
STRAIGHT  
or  
EFFECT  
EFFECT  
Enjoying multi-channel sources and  
sound field programs with headphones  
(SILENT CINEMA)  
STRAIGHT  
SILENT CINEMA allows you to enjoy multi-channel  
music or movie sound, including Dolby Digital and DTS  
sources, through ordinary headphones. SILENT CINEMA  
activates automatically whenever you connect headphones  
to the PHONES jack while listening to CINEMA DSP or  
HiFi DSP sound field programs (see page 47). When  
activated, the SILENT CINEMA indicator lights up in the  
front panel display.  
Format  
Description  
Standard processing for Dolby  
Digital sources.  
Dolby Digital  
Standard processing for DTS  
sources. When the input source is  
DTS-ES Discrete or DTS-ES  
Matrix format, the respective  
indicator appears in the front  
panel display.  
DTS  
Notes  
• SILENT CINEMA does not activate when the component  
connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the  
input source (see page 43).  
• SILENT CINEMA is not effective when the Pure Direct (see  
page 52) or “2ch Stereo” mode (see page 53) is selected, or  
when this unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode (see page 51).  
Plays back DSD (Direct Stream  
Digital) sources.  
DSD  
PCM  
Plays back PCM (Pulse Code  
Modulation) sources.  
Plays back multi-channel PCM  
(Pulse Code Modulation) sources.  
MPCM  
Plays back analog sources.  
Analog  
Deactivating the “STRAIGHT” mode  
Press STRAIGHT on the remote control so that  
“STRAIGHT” disappears from the front panel  
display.  
The sound effect is turned back on.  
STRAIGHT  
STRAIGHT  
or  
EFFECT  
EFFECT  
51 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Enjoying pure hi-fi sound  
Adjusting the tonal quality  
Use the Pure Direct mode to enjoy the pure fidelity sound  
of the selected source. When the Pure Direct mode is  
activated, this unit plays back the selected source with the  
least circuitry.  
Use this feature to adjust the balance of bass and treble for  
the front L/R, center, presence L/R speaker channels and  
the subwoofer channel.  
1
Press TONE CONTROL on the front panel  
repeatedly to select the high-frequency  
response (TREBLE) or the low-frequency  
response (BASS).  
Press PURE DIRECT on the front panel (or on the  
remote control) to turn on or off the Pure Direct  
mode.  
The PURE DIRECT button on the front panel lights up  
while this unit is in the Pure Direct mode. The front panel  
display automatically dims.  
TONE  
CONTROL  
PURE DIRECT  
PURE DIRECT  
or  
2
Rotate the PROGRAM selector to adjust the  
high-frequency response (TREBLE) or the  
low-frequency response (BASS).  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Notes  
• When you play back the multi-channel PCM sources (less than  
192 kHz), this unit downmixes the multi-channel signals  
according to the “Speaker Set” in “Basic” (see page 105).  
• When the component connected to the HDMI IN jacks is  
selected as the input source and Audio input jack select is set to  
“AUTO” or “HDMI”, this unit does not turn off the video  
circuitry in the Pure Direct mode.  
PROGRAM  
Bypassing the tone control circuitry  
• When you set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”, “HDMI” or  
“COAX/OPT” (see page 42) and play back the Dolby Digital,  
DTS or multi channel PCM sources, this unit activates the  
corresponding decoder.  
Press TONE CONTROL repeatedly to select  
BYPASS and cancel the tone control.  
• The following operations are not possible when this unit is in  
the Pure Direct mode:  
TONE  
CONTROL  
– switching the sound field program  
– displaying the GUI screen  
– operating video functions (video conversion, etc.)  
• The Pure Direct mode is automatically canceled whenever this  
unit is turned off.  
Notes  
• If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or the  
low-frequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality of  
the surround speakers may not match that of the front L/R,  
center, presence L/R speakers and the subwoofer.  
• TONE CONTROL is not effective when PURE DIRECT is  
selected, or when MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input  
source.  
y
The front panel display turns on momentarily when an operation  
is performed.  
y
Use “Tone Control” parameter in “Sound” menu to adjust the  
balance of bass and treble output to your speakers or headphones  
by using GUI screen. See page 99 for details.  
52 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Adjusting the speaker level  
You can adjust the output level of each speaker while  
listening to a music source. This is also possible when  
playing sources input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.  
Enjoying multi-channel sources in  
2-channel stereo  
You can mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels  
and enjoy playback in 2-channel stereo.  
Note  
Set the operation mode to AMP and then press  
STEREO on the remote control repeatedly to  
select “2ch Stereo”.  
This operation will override the level adjustments made in “Auto  
Setup” (see page 35) and “Speaker Level” (see page 109).  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press LEVEL on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the speaker you want to  
adjust.  
AMP  
STEREO  
SOURCE  
5
TV  
AMP  
LEVEL  
SOURCE  
TITLE  
TV  
2ch Stereo  
y
Display  
FRONT L  
CENTER  
FRONT R  
SUR. R  
SB L  
Adjusted speaker  
Front left speaker  
You can use a subwoofer with this program when “Bass Out” is  
set to “SWFR” or “Both” (see page 107).  
You can also select the “2ch Stereo” mode by rotating the  
PROGRAM selector on the front panel.  
You can also select the “2ch Stereo” mode and adjust the  
parameter by using GUI screen. See page 88 for details.  
Center speaker  
Front right speaker  
Surround right speaker  
Surround back right speaker  
Surround back left speaker  
Surround left speaker  
Subwoofer  
SB R  
SUR. L  
SWFR  
Presence left speaker  
Presence right speaker  
PRNS L  
PRNS R  
y
• Once you press LEVEL on the remote control, you can  
also select the speaker by pressing k/ n.  
• Instead of “SB R” and “SB L”, “SB” is displayed if  
“Surround Back” is set to either “Small x1” or “Large x1”  
2
Press l/ hon the remote control to adjust  
the speaker output level.  
• Press hto increase the value.  
• Press lto decrease the value.  
Control range: –10 dB to +10 dB  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
53 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Choices: 2ch Enhancer, 7ch Enhancer, Off  
• Select “2ch Enhancer” to play back compression  
artifacts in 2-channel stereo.  
• Select “7ch Enhancer” to play back compression  
artifacts in 7-channel stereo.  
Selecting the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode  
Compression artifacts (such as the MP3 format) are  
created by a lossy compression scheme where the audio is  
resampled to lower the bit rate and to remove sounds that  
are indistinguishable to typical human hearing. The  
Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances  
your listening experience by regenerating the missing  
harmonics in a compression artifact. As a result, flattened  
complexity due to the loss of high-frequency fidelity as  
well as lack of bass due to the loss of low-frequency bass  
is compensated, providing improved performance of the  
overall sound system.  
• Select “Off” to turn off the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode.  
Note  
When you select “Off”, this unit returns to the previously  
selected sound field program.  
Notes  
• When you play back DSD sources or PCM sources whose  
sampling frequencies are higher than 48 kHz, this unit samples  
them down to 48 kHz or lower and applies the Compressed  
Music Enhancer mode.  
• The Compressed Music Enhancer mode is not effective with  
any of the sound field programs.  
y
You can also select the Compressed Music Enhancer mode and  
adjust the parameter by using GUI menu. See page 88 for details.  
Press ENHANCER on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to AMP and then press  
ENHANCER on the remote control) repeatedly to  
select the desired Compressed Music Enhancer  
mode.  
The following short message appears on the video monitor  
and the ENHANCER indicator lights up in the front panel  
display.  
AMP  
ENHANCER  
ENHANCER  
SOURCE  
or  
ENT  
TV  
ENHANCER  
Lights up  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀMUSICꢀENHANCER  
2chꢀEnhancerꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
54 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
y
“NIGHT:CINEMA” and “NIGHT:MUSIC” adjustments are  
stored independently.  
Selecting the night listening mode  
The night listening modes are designed to improve  
listenability at lower volumes or at night. Choose either  
“NIGHT:CINEMA” or “NIGHT:MUSIC” depending on  
the type of material you are playing.  
Notes  
You cannot use the night listening modes in the following  
cases:  
– when the Pure Direct mode (see page 52) is selected.  
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH  
INPUT jacks is selected as the input source (see  
page 43).  
– when headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.  
• The night listening modes may vary in effectiveness  
depending on the input source and surround sound settings  
you use.  
1
Press NIGHT on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press NIGHT on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “NIGHT:CINEMA” or  
“NIGHT:MUSIC”.  
AMP  
NIGHT  
NIGHT  
SOURCE  
or  
+
10  
TV  
Choices: NIGHT:CINEMA, NIGHT:MUSIC, OFF  
• Select “NIGHT:CINEMA” when watching films to  
reduce the dynamic range of film soundtracks and  
make dialog easier to hear at lower volumes.  
• Select “NIGHT:MUSIC” when listening to music  
sources to preserve ease-of-listening for all sounds.  
• Select “OFF” if you do not want to use this feature.  
y
When a night listening mode is selected, the NIGHT  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
2
Press l/ hon the remote control to adjust  
the effect level while “NIGHT:CINEMA” or  
“NIGHT:MUSIC” is displayed in the front  
panel display.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Remote control  
Effect.Lvl:MID  
Choices: MIN, MID, MAX  
• Select “MIN” for minimum compression.  
• Select “MID” for standard compression.  
• Select “MAX” for maximum compression.  
55 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FM/AM TUNING  
FM/AM TUNING  
There are 2 tuning methods: automatic and manual. Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are strong and  
there is no interference. If the signal from the station you want to select is weak, tune into it manually. You can also use  
the automatic and manual preset tuning features to store up to 40 stations (A1 to E8: 8 preset station numbers in each of  
the 5 preset station groups). Furthermore, you can recall any preset stations and exchange the assignment of two preset  
stations with each other.  
Note  
Orient the connected FM and AM antennas for the best reception.  
FM/AM controls and functions  
Front panel functions  
Remote control functions  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
1
2
3
45 6 7  
POWER  
STANDBY  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
1
TUNER  
DTV  
CD  
CD-R  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
CONTROL  
PRESET/TUNING  
FM/AM  
1
EDIT  
CBL/SAT  
DVR/VCR  
NET/USB  
MD/TAPE  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
SELECT  
MULTI ZONE  
VCR  
1
2
DVD  
V-AUX/DOCK  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
Set to  
SOURCE  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
PRESET  
VOLUME  
MUTE  
3
5
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
(U.S.A. model)  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
2
3
SRCH MODE  
1 INPUT selector  
Selects “TUNER” as the input source.  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
5
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
ID1 ID2  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
3
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
2 A/B/C/D/E  
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
4
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E) (see  
9
0
+
(U.S.A. model)  
3 PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h  
Selects one of the 8 preset station numbers (1 to 8)  
when the colon (:) is displayed in the front panel  
1 TUNER  
Selects “TUNER” as the input source. This unit is turned  
into the last selected station.  
Selects the tuning frequency when the colon (:) is not  
displayed in the front panel display (see page 58).  
2 BAND  
Switches the reception band between FM and AM (see  
page 57). This unit is turned into the last selected AM or  
FM station.  
4 PRESET/TUNING, EDIT  
Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING/CH  
l
/
h
between selecting preset station numbers and selecting  
the tuning frequency.  
3 PRESET/CH k/ n  
Selects one of the 8 preset station numbers (1 to 8) when  
the colon (:) is displayed in the front panel display (see  
page 60).  
Edits the assignments of preset stations (see page 60).  
5 FM/AM  
Switches the reception band between FM and AM (see  
4 Numeric buttons  
Use numbers 1 through 8 to select preset stations (see  
page 61).  
6 MEMORY  
Stores a preset station in the memory. Hold down this  
button for more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset  
5 A-E/CAT. l/ h, A/B/C/D/E  
Selects one of the preset station groups (A to E) (see  
page 59).  
7 TUNING MODE  
Switches between automatic tuning (the AUTO indicator  
is turned on) and manual tuning (the AUTO indicator is  
56 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
FM/AM TUNING  
Automatic tuning  
Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are  
strong and there is no interference.  
3
Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
TUNING  
MODE  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
AUTO  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
A FM 97.70MHz  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
No colon (:)  
Lights up  
1
4 3 2 3  
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning  
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING to turn the  
colon (:) off.  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
PRESET/  
INPUT  
EDIT  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ honce to  
begin automatic tuning.  
When this unit is tuned into a station, the TUNED  
indicator lights up and the frequency of the received  
station is shown in the front panel display.  
• Press hto tune into a higher frequency.  
• Press lto tune into a lower frequency.  
Front panel  
Press FM/AM to select the reception band.  
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.  
FM/AM  
PRESET/TUNING  
or  
FM  
AM  
TUNED  
A FM 97.70MHz  
Lights up  
57 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FM/AM TUNING  
Manual tuning  
If the signal received from the station you want to select is  
weak, tune into it manually.  
3
Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO  
indicator disappears from the front panel  
display.  
TUNING  
MODE  
Note  
Manually tuning into an FM station automatically switches the  
tuner to monaural reception to increase the signal quality.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
A FM 97.70MHz  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
No colon (:)  
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning  
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to  
turn the colon (:) off.  
1
4 3 2 3  
PRESET/  
EDIT  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hto tune  
into the desired station manually.  
Hold down the button to continue searching.  
INPUT  
PRESET/TUNING  
Front panel  
Press FM/AM to select the reception band.  
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.  
FM/AM  
or  
FM  
AM  
58 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FM/AM TUNING  
Automatic preset tuning  
3
Press and hold MEMORY for more than 3  
seconds.  
The preset station number as well as the MEMORY  
and AUTO indicators flashes. After approximately 5  
seconds, automatic presetting starts from the current  
frequency and proceeds toward higher frequencies.  
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store up  
to 40 FM stations with strong signals (A1 to E8: 8 preset  
station numbers in each of the 5 preset station groups) in  
order. You can then recall any preset station easily by  
selecting the preset station number.  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
AUTO MEMORY  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
A1:FM 97.70MHz  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
Flashes  
Flashes  
1
2 3  
When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front  
panel display shows the frequency of the last preset  
station.  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
y
INPUT  
You can specify the preset number from which this unit  
stores FM stations. Press A/B/C/D/E and then PRESET/  
TUNING/CH l/ hrepeatedly after you perform step 3  
to select the preset station number under which the first  
station will be stored.  
You can begin tuning toward lower frequencies to store  
FM stations automatically. Press PRESET/TUNING so  
that the colon (:) disappears from the front panel display  
and then press PRESET/TUNING/CH lafter pressing  
and holding MEMORY for more than 3 seconds.  
Front panel  
Press FM/AM to select “FM” as the reception  
band.  
Notes  
“FM” appears in the front panel display.  
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station  
number is cleared when you store a new station under the  
same preset station number.  
• If the number of received stations does not reach 40 (E8),  
automatic preset tuning automatically stops after  
searching for all the available stations.  
FM/AM  
FM  
• Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored  
automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station  
you want to store is weak in signal strength, tune into it  
manually and store it as described in “Manual preset  
59 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
FM/AM TUNING  
Manual preset tuning  
You can also store up to 40 stations (A1 to E8: 8 preset  
station numbers in each of the 5 preset station groups)  
manually.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hto select a  
preset station number (1 to 8) while the  
MEMORY indicator is flashing.  
• Press hto select a higher preset station number.  
• Press lto select a lower preset station number.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/TUNING  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
MEMORY  
A1:FM 97.70MHz  
3 4  
2,5  
Preset station number  
Flashes  
1
2
Tune into a station automatically or manually.  
See pages 57 and 58 for tuning instructions.  
5
Press MEMORY while the MEMORY indicator  
is flashing.  
The station band and frequency appear in the front  
panel display with the preset station group and  
number you have selected. The MEMORY indicator  
disappears from the front panel display.  
Press MEMORY.  
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel  
display for approximately 5 seconds.  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
MEMORY  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
Flashes  
3
Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset  
station group (A to E) while the MEMORY  
indicator is flashing.  
The selected preset station group letter appears.  
Check that the colon (:) appears in the front panel  
display.  
A1:FM 97.70MHz  
The displayed station has been stored as A1.  
A/B/C/D/E  
Notes  
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station  
number is cleared when you store a new station under the  
same preset station number.  
• The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along  
with the station frequency.  
MEMORY  
A :FM 97.70MHz  
Preset station Colon (:)  
group  
Flashes  
60 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
FM/AM TUNING  
Selecting preset stations  
You can tune into any desired station simply by selecting  
the preset station group and number under which it was  
stored.  
2
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) to select the desired preset  
station number (1 to 8).  
The preset station group and number appear in the  
front panel display along with the station band and  
frequency.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
PRESET/CH  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PRESET/TUNING  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
or  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
ENTER  
MASTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Remote control  
Front panel  
1 2  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
1
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
SRCH MODE  
A1:FM 97.70MHz  
ENTER  
1,2  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
y
When performing this operation with the remote control, set the  
operation mode selector to SOURCE and then press TUNER to  
select “TUNER” as the input source.  
1
Press A/B/C/D/E on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to SOURCE and  
then press A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote  
control) to select the desired preset station  
group (A to E).  
The preset station group letter appears in the front  
panel display and changes each time you press the  
button.  
A/B/C/D/E  
Front panel  
or  
PRESET/CH  
AMP  
SOURCE  
ENTER  
TV  
A/B/C/D/E  
Remote control  
61 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FM/AM TUNING  
Exchanging preset stations  
You can exchange the assignments of two preset stations  
with each other. The example below describes the  
procedure to exchange preset station “E1” with “A5”.  
3
Select preset station “A5” using A/B/C/D/E  
and PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h.  
“A5” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front  
panel display.  
(U.S.A. model)  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
MEMORY  
A5:FM 97.70MHz  
3 3 2,4  
Flashes  
Flashes  
1
2
Select preset station “E1” using A/B/C/D/E  
and PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h.  
4
Press EDIT again.  
“EDIT E1–A5” appears in the front panel display and  
the assignments of the two preset stations are  
exchanged.  
Press and hold EDIT for more than 3  
seconds.  
“E1” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front  
panel display.  
PRESET/  
EDIT  
PRESET/  
EDIT  
EDIT E1-A5  
MEMORY  
E1:FM 97.70MHz  
Flashes  
Flashes  
62 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM Satellite Radio is a satellite radio service with millions of listeners across the United States and Canada,  
broadcasting live daily. The XM Satellite Radio channel lineup includes over 160 digital channels of choice from coast to  
coast: 67 commercial-free music channels, featuring hip hop to opera, classical to country, bluegrass to blues; 33  
channels of premier sports, talk, comedy, children’s and entertainment programming; and more than 20 channels of the  
traffic and weather information for major metropolitan areas nationwide.  
Because XM Satellite Radio is a subscription service, you will need to set up an account and activate service with XM  
using your XM Satellite Radio ID number. To check your ID number, follow “Activating XM Satellite Radio” on  
page 65. For further information on XM Satellite Radio services, visit the XM Satellite Radio website at  
“http://www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States) or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada).  
This unit is equipped with the Neural Surround decoder (U.S.A. and Canada models only) that plays back the surround  
sound content of the XM Satellite Radio broadcasts in multi-channels, resulting in a full surround sound experience.  
Notes  
Connecting the XM Passport System  
• The XM Satellite Radio service is only available in the 48  
Connect XM Passport and XM Passport Home Dock (sold  
contiguous United States (not available in Alaska and Hawaii)  
separately) to the XM jack on the rear panel of this unit.  
and Canada.  
For details, see the operating instructions provided with  
XM Passport System.  
• XM Passport System and monthly subscription are sold  
separately. For details, visit the XM Satellite Radio website at  
“http://www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States)  
XM  
or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada).  
• For information on obtaining the XM Passport System, visit the  
XM Satellite Radio website at  
“http://www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States)  
or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada), or  
consult your local retailer that sells XM Ready products.  
(U.S.A. model)  
• To ensure optimal reception of the XM Satellite Radio signals,  
the XM Passport System must be placed at or near a southerly  
facing window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. You can  
mount it indoors or outdoors.  
Information from XM Satellite Radio Inc.  
XM Passport and  
XM Passport Home Dock  
(sold separately)  
XM monthly service subscription sold separately. XM  
Passport and XM Passport Home Dock required to receive  
XM service (sold separately). Installation costs and other  
fees and taxes, including a one-time activation fee may  
apply. Subscription fee is consumer only. All fees and  
programming subject to change. Channels with frequent  
explicit language are indicated with an “XL”. Channel  
blocking is available for XM radio receivers by calling “1-  
800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-2346)” (for residents in the  
United States) or “1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677)”  
(for residents in Canada). Subscriptions subject to  
Customer Agreement available at “http://  
www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States) or  
“http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada). XM  
service only available in the 48 continuous United States  
and Canada. “XM Ready” is a trademark of XM Satellite  
Radio Inc. © 2006 XM Satellite Radio Inc. All rights  
reserved.  
63 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM Satellite Radio controls and functions  
Note  
The following controls are available only when “XM” is selected as the input source. Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel (or  
set the operation mode selector to SOURCE and then press XM on the remote control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
Front panel functions  
Remote control functions  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
XM  
1
4
XM  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
STANDBY  
1
2
3
4
5 6  
TUNER  
CD  
CD-R  
1
2
3
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
1
MD/T  
APE NET/USB  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
4
5
6
ENT  
CONTROL  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
FM/AM  
8
EDIT  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR  
2
DVD  
V-AUX/DOCK  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLAY  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
INPUT  
7
8
9
0
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
SELECT  
PRESET  
VOLUME  
MUTE  
Set to  
SOURCE  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
A/B/C/D/E  
(U.S.A. model)  
7
A
B
6
2
9
A-E/CAT.  
DISPLAY  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ALL  
PRESET  
CAT.  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
5
SRCH MODE  
ID1 ID2  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
3
1 INPUT selector  
Selects “XM” as the input source.  
NUMBER  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
2
3
0
A-E/CAT.  
6
7
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2 CATEGORY  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Changes the channel category while staying in the All  
Channel Search mode.  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
4
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
8
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
(Category Search mode)  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
Changes the channel category.  
(Preset Search mode)  
Changes the preset channel group (A to E).  
(U.S.A. model)  
3 PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within all channels. Press and hold  
for quick search.  
1 XM  
Selects “XM” as the input source.  
2 PRESET/CH k/ n  
(Category Search mode)  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within the selected category. Press  
and hold for quick search.  
Searches for a channel within all channels. Press and hold  
for quick search.  
(Preset Search mode)  
(Category Search mode)  
Changes the preset channel number (1 to 8).  
Searches for a channel within the selected category. Press  
and hold for quick search.  
(Preset Search mode)  
4 SEARCH MODE  
Changes the search mode between the All Channel  
Search, Category Search, and Preset Search modes  
(see page 68).  
Changes the preset channel number (1 to 8).  
3 MEMORY  
Stores a preset channel in the memory (see page 72).  
5 MEMORY  
Stores a preset channel in the memory (see page 72).  
4 Numeric buttons  
(All Channel Search or Category Search mode)  
Use 1 to 9 and 0 to enter a channel number directly.  
(Preset Search mode)  
6 DISPLAY  
Displays the XM Satellite Radio information such as  
channel number, channel name, category, artist name, or  
song title displayed in the front panel display or in the  
Use 1 to 8 to enter a preset channel number directly.  
64 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
5 SRCH MODE  
Activating XM Satellite Radio  
Changes the search mode between the All Channel  
Search, Category Search, and Preset Search modes  
(see page 68).  
To sign up for an account with the XM Satellite Radio  
service, an XM Satellite Radio ID number is required.  
Follow the procedure below to check your ID number, and  
then visit the website or call toll-free with a major credit  
card handy for signing up.  
6 A-E/CAT. l/ h  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Changes the channel category.  
(Category Search mode)  
Changes the channel category.  
(Preset Search mode)  
For residents in the United States  
URL: http://activate.xmradio.com/  
Toll-free: 1-800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-2346)  
Changes the preset channel group (A to E).  
For residents in Canada  
URL: https://activate.xmradio.ca/on-line-activation/  
activation.jsp  
7 DISPLAY  
Displays the XM Satellite Radio information such as  
channel number, channel name, category, artist name, or  
song title displayed in the front panel display or on the  
video monitor (see page 73).  
Toll-free: 1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677)  
8 ENT  
Confirms an entered channel number in the Direct  
Number Access mode (see page 71).  
9 ALL  
Selects the All Channel Search mode (see page 68).  
0 NUMBER  
Press and hold before you press the input selector or  
numeric buttons to switch the function to entering  
numbers.  
A PRESET  
Selects the Preset Search Mode (see page 70).  
B CAT.  
Selects the Category Search mode (see page 69).  
65 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
(U.S.A. model)  
2
Check the XM Satellite Radio reception level  
and adjust the orientation of XM Passport  
System for a better percentage of the  
reception level.  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
y
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio reception level by  
using the “Antenna Level” parameter in “Input Select” (see  
page 94).  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
1
3
Notes  
• If “CHECK ANTENNA” appears in the front panel  
display, XM Passport System may not be connected to the  
XM jack on the rear panel of this unit properly. See  
check the connection.  
• The “Antenna Level” parameter in “Input Select” (See  
page 94) cannot be adjusted by using the remote control.  
Instead, you need to adjust the orientation of XM Passport  
System connected to the XM jack of this unit for a better  
percentage of the reception level.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
+
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
TV VOL  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
1
TV  
XM  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
1
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
3
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to  
SOURCE and then press XM on the remote  
control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
The cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up in  
the front panel display.  
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) to select channel “0”.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/TUNING  
or  
ENTER  
INPUT  
A/B/C/D/E  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Note  
Front panel  
You cannot select channel “0” if the All Channel Search  
mode (see page 68) is not selected.  
or  
AMP  
4
Check the XM Satellite Radio ID number  
displayed in the front panel display and write  
it down.  
XM  
SOURCE  
TV  
Remote control  
ID:_____________________________________  
Lights up  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
66 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Basic XM Satellite Radio  
operations  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to  
SOURCE and then press XM on the remote  
control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
The cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up in  
the front panel display and the XM Satellite Radio  
information (such as channel number, channel name,  
category, artist name, or song title) for the currently  
selected channel appears in the front panel display.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
INPUT  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
INPUT selector  
Front panel  
POWER  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
TV  
XM  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
or  
XM button  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
AMP  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
XM  
SOURCE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
TV  
SELECT  
Remote control  
Lights up  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
Set to SOURCE  
(U.S.A. model)  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
[001] Preview  
y
When you select “XM” as the input source, this unit  
automatically recalls the previously selected channel.  
Note  
The XM Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the  
AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.  
2
Search for a channel by using one of the XM  
Satellite Radio search modes.  
• To select a channel from the all channel list, see  
“All Channel Search mode” on page 68.  
• To select a channel by category, see “Category  
Search mode” on page 69.  
• To select a channel from the preset channels, see  
“Preset Search mode” on page 70.  
• To select the desired channel directly by entering  
the channel number, see “Direct Number Access  
mode” on page 71.  
y
You can use the Neural Surround decoder to enjoy the  
surround sound content of XM Satellite Radio broadcasts  
in multi-channels (see page 84).  
You can set the XM Satellite Radio preset channels (see  
page 72).  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio information in the  
front panel display or on the video monitor (see page 73).  
67 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
All Channel Search mode  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or  
A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote control)  
repeatedly to change the channel category.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
PRESET/CH  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
A/B/C/D/E  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
or  
ENTER  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Front panel  
Remote control  
2
3 1  
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to search for a  
channel within all channels.  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
PRESET/CH  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/TUNING  
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
or  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH”.  
Front panel  
PRESET/  
Remote control  
SET MENU  
or  
MENU  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
y
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and  
holding PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the front panel  
(or PRESET/CH k/ non the remote control).  
Front panel  
Remote control  
ALL CH SEARCH  
68 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Category Search mode  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or  
A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote control)  
repeatedly to change the channel category.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
PRESET/CH  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
A/B/C/D/E  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
or  
ENTER  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Front panel  
Remote control  
2
3 1  
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to search for a  
channel within the selected channel  
category.  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/CH  
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “CAT SEARCH”.  
PRESET/TUNING  
or  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
Front panel  
SET MENU  
Remote control  
MENU  
or  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
y
Front panel  
Remote control  
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and  
holding PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the front panel  
(or PRESET/CH k/ non the remote control).  
CAT SEARCH  
69 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Preset Search mode  
Prior to selecting a preset channel in the Preset Search  
mode, you must preset XM Satellite Radio channels. For  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or  
A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote control)  
repeatedly to change the preset channel  
group (A to E).  
y
PRESET/CH  
The initial factory setting of all preset channels (A1 to E8) is  
“[001] Preview”.  
A/B/C/D/E  
or  
ENTER  
(U.S.A. model)  
A/B/C/D/E  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
Front panel  
Remote control  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to change the  
preset channel number (1 to 8).  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
2
3 1  
PRESET/CH  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
PRESET/TUNING  
SRCH MODE  
or  
ENTER  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
A/B/C/D/E  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
Front panel  
Remote control  
y
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “PRESET SEARCH”.  
You can also select the preset channel number directly by  
pressing the numeric buttons (1 to 8) on the remote control.  
PRESET/  
SET MENU  
MENU  
or  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
Front panel  
Remote control  
PRESET SEARCH  
70 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Direct Number Access mode  
2
Press the numeric buttons on the remote  
control to enter the desired three-digit  
channel number.  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
For example, to enter the number 123, press the  
numeric buttons as shown below.  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
2
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
ENTERTAIN  
CLASSICAL  
1
LIVE/CLUB  
9
0
+
3
2
(U.S.A. model)  
The display changes as follows.  
1
Press SRCH MODE on the remote control  
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH” or  
“CAT SEARCH”.  
<XM> --1  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
Remote control  
<XM> -12  
ALL CH SEARCH  
or  
<XM>123  
CAT SEARCH  
y
• To enter a one-digit or two-digit channel number, press the  
numeric buttons on the remote control and then press ENT  
to confirm the input number.  
• Instead of pressing ENT to tune into the channel  
immediately, you can wait a few seconds until this unit  
confirms the entered channel number.  
• If no button is pressed within a few seconds after you enter  
a one-digit or two-digit number, this unit automatically  
confirms the entered channel number.  
• Pressing a button other than the numeric buttons or ENT  
cancels the Direct Number Access mode procedure.  
71 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Setting the XM Satellite Radio  
preset channels  
You can use this feature to store up to 40 XM Satellite  
Radio channels (A1 to E8: 8 preset channel numbers in  
each of the 5 preset channel groups). You can then recall  
any preset channel easily by selecting the preset channel  
group and number as described in “Preset Search mode”  
on page 70.  
2
Press MEMORY on the front panel (or  
MEMORY on the remote control).  
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel  
display for approximately 5 seconds.  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
RETURN  
or  
MEMORY  
Front panel  
Remote control  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
MEMORY  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
Flashes  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
Note  
You must proceed to and carry out steps 3 through 5 while  
the MEMORY indicator is flashing in the front panel  
display.  
3 4  
2,5  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
3
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or  
A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote control)  
repeatedly to select a preset channel group  
(A to E) while the MEMORY indicator is  
flashing.  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
3,4  
2,5  
A-E/CAT.  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
The preset channel group letter appears in the front  
panel display.  
1
Search for a channel you want to set as a  
preset channel by using one of the XM  
Satellite Radio search modes.  
PRESET/CH  
A/B/C/D/E  
page 67 for details.  
ENTER  
or  
A/B/C/D/E  
Front panel  
Remote control  
[043] XMU  
Currently selected channel number  
MEMORY  
C [043] XMU  
Currently selected preset channel group  
Flashes  
72 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio information (such  
as channel number, channel name, category, artist name,  
or song title) for the currently selected channel in the front  
panel display or in the OSD.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to select a preset  
channel number (1 to 8) while the MEMORY  
indicator is flashing.  
The preset channel number appears in the front panel  
display.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/CH  
PURE DIRECT  
PRESET/TUNING  
or  
VOLUME  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
CATEGORY  
STRAIGHT  
SEARCH MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
INPUT  
A/B/C/D/E  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
Front panel  
Remote control  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
C5 [043] XMU  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
TITLE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
DISPLAY  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
Flashes  
MEMORY  
Currently selected preset channel number  
(U.S.A. model)  
5
Press MEMORY on the front panel (or  
Note  
MEMORY on the remote control) to set the  
selected XM Satellite Radio channel as a  
preset channel while the MEMORY indicator  
is flashing.  
If a status message or an error message appears in the front panel  
display or on the video monitor, see the “XM Satellite Radio  
“TROUBLESHOOTING” on page 139 for appropriate remedies.  
A colon (:) appears next to the preset channel number  
for confirmation, and the MEMORY indicator turns  
off in the front panel display.  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information in the front panel display  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
Press DISPLAY on the front panel or on the  
remote control repeatedly to toggle between the  
following XM Satellite Radio information display  
modes.  
RETURN  
or  
MEMORY  
Front panel  
Remote control  
TUNING  
MODE  
Channel number / name  
Front panel  
C5: [043] XMU  
Channel category  
or  
Colon (:)  
DISPLAY  
Artist name / Song title  
Note  
Remote control  
Once you set a new preset channel, the one previously  
stored in the same preset channel group and number is  
cleared.  
73 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
When the channel number / name is displayed:  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information on the video monitor  
[043] XMU  
When the channel category is displayed:  
<CAT>Rock  
Press DISPLAY on the remote control.  
The following information screen is displayed on the  
video monitor.  
TUNING  
MODE  
or  
DISPLAY  
Front panel  
Remote control  
When the artist name / song title is displayed:  
XM Information  
All CH Search  
CH NUMBER 043  
CH NAME  
CATEGORY  
NAME  
XMU  
Rock  
Coldplay  
Coldplay / Spe  
TITLE  
Speed of sound  
Hold : ENTER  
y
• The front panel display can indicate up to 14 alphanumeric  
characters at once. You can set whether to display the XM  
Satellite Radio information in the front panel display in a  
continuous manner or by 14 alphanumeric characters at once by  
using the “Scroll” parameter in “Front Panel Disp.” (see  
• If the XM Satellite Radio information contains a character that  
cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be  
displayed with a space.  
y
• To turn off the displayed information screen, press DISPLAY  
on the front panel (or on the remote control).  
You can select the amount of time the XM Satellite Radio  
information is displayed in on the video monitor by using the  
“On Screen” parameter in “Manual Setup” (see page 103).  
• To hold the XM Satellite Radio information screen, press  
ENTER on the remote control while it is being displayed on the  
video monitor.  
• The XM Satellite Radio information screen on hold is released  
if you press ENTER on the remote control again or if you  
change the XM Satellite Radio channel.  
• This unit can save up to two XM Satellite Radio information  
screens for future reference. To view the previous two XM  
Satellite Radio information screens, press TITLE on the remote  
control repeatedly while the current XM Satellite Radio  
information screen is being hold.  
Note  
If you press DISPLAY while the XM Satellite Radio information  
display is scrolling from right to left in the front panel display, the  
XM Satellite Radio information display mode toggles as  
described above.  
74 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING IPOD  
USING iPod  
Once you have stationed your iPod in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately) connected  
to the DOCK terminal of this unit (see page 29), you can enjoy playback of your iPod using the supplied remote control.  
You can also use the Compressed Music Enhancer mode of this unit to improve the sound quality of the compression  
artifacts (such as the MP3 format) stored on your iPod (see page 54).  
Notes  
• Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod mini are supported.  
• Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or the software version of your iPod.  
y
• For a complete list of the remote control functions used to control your iPod, see the “iPod” column in “Controlling other  
• For a complete list of status messages that appear in the front panel display and on the video monitor, see the “iPod” section in  
• Once your iPod is stationed in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately) connected to the DOCK  
terminal of this unit, this unit begins signal transmission with your iPod.  
• Once the connection between your iPod and this unit is complete, “iPod connected” appears in the front panel display and the DOCK  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
• Only the analog audio and video signals of your iPod are input at the DOCK terminal, and the analog audio signals can be output at the  
analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.  
Your iPod battery is automatically charged when your iPod is stationed in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold  
separately) connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit as long as this unit is turned on. You can also select whether this unit charges  
the battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the standby mode by selecting the “Standby Charge” parameter in “iPod”  
• While the stationed iPod is being charged in the standby mode of this unit, the battery charge indicator (see page 12) appears in the  
front panel display. Once the charge is complete (or after 4 hours from the start of the charge), the indicator disappears.  
Controlling iPod in the menu browse  
Controlling iPod  
mode  
You can perform the advanced operations of your iPod  
You can control your iPod when “V-AUX” is selected as  
using the supplied remote control with the aid of the GUI  
the input source. The operations of your iPod can be done  
screen of this unit. The name of the song being played  
with the aid of the GUI screen of this unit (menu browse  
appears in the front panel display according to the “Scroll”  
mode) or without it (simple remote mode).  
parameter in “Front Panel Disp.” (see page 112). You can  
also browse the songs stored on your iPod in the GUI  
screen. Further, you can change or adjust settings for your  
iPod to suit your personal preferences.  
Controlling iPod in the simple remote  
mode  
You can perform the basic operations of your iPod (play,  
stop, skip, etc.) using the supplied remote control without  
the aid of the GUI screen of this unit.  
Notes  
• Operations cannot be done with the controls on your iPod.  
• The YAMAHA logo appears in the display window of your  
y
You can view the photos or video clips stored on your iPod.  
iPod.  
• Operations can be also done with the controls on your iPod.  
• There are some characters that cannot be displayed in the front  
panel display or in the GUI screen of this unit. Those characters  
are replaced with underscores “_”.  
• The “Settings” parameters can be changed or adjusted only in  
the GUI screen. Press ENTER on the remote control to toggle  
between the “Settings” parameter settings.  
You cannot browse the photos or video clips stored on your  
iPod in the GUI screen. Instead, you must use the controls on  
your iPod to select the desired photos or video clips.  
You can select the amount of time the GUI screen of iPod is  
displayed in on the video monitor by using the “On Screen”  
parameter in “Manual Setup” (see page 103).  
75 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING iPod  
Shuffle (Shuffle)  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press DISPLAY on the remote  
control.  
Use this feature to set this unit to play songs or albums in  
random order.  
Choices: Off, Songs, Albums  
Select “Offto deactivate this feature.  
Select “Songs” to set this unit to play songs in random  
order.  
The following display appears in the video monitor.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
Select “Albums” to set this unit to play albums in  
random order.  
DISPLAY  
TV  
Note  
Top  
When “Shuffle” is set to a setting other than “Off , “  
” appears  
Playlists  
Artists  
Albums  
Songs  
Genres  
Composers  
Settings  
in the top right corner while songs or albums are being shuffled.  
Repeat (Repeat)  
Use this feature to set this unit to repeat one song or a  
sequence of songs.  
Choices: Off, One, All  
Select “Offto deactivate this feature.  
Select “One” to set this unit to repeat one song.  
Select “All” to set this unit to repeat a sequence of  
songs.  
2
Press k/ n / l/ hon the remote control to  
navigate the iPod menu and then press  
ENTER to begin playback of the selected  
song.  
Note  
When “Repeat” is set to a setting other than “Off , “ or “  
appears in the top right corner while one song or a sequence of  
songs are being repeated.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
The functions of the play information  
ENTER  
display  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Play Information  
5
6
7
1/9  
Frankie Zipper  
Made-to-order  
Road to India  
1
2
3
Choices: Playlists (playlists), Artists (artists),  
Albums (albums), Songs (songs),  
Genres (genres), Composers (composers),  
Settings (settings)  
8
9
• Playlists > Songs  
• Artists > Albums > Songs  
• Albums > Songs  
0:51  
-7:44  
4
• Songs  
1 Track number/total tracks  
2 Name of the album  
3 Name of the song  
4 Elapsed time  
• Genres > Artists > Albums > Songs  
• Composers > Albums > Songs  
• Settings > Shuffle, Repeat  
5 h(playback) or e(pausing)  
6 Shuffle and repeat icons  
7 Name of the artist  
8 Progress bar  
9 Remaining time  
76 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
This unit is equipped with network and USB features that allow you to enjoy WAV (PCM format only), MP3 and WMA  
files saved on your PC, YAMAHA MCX-2000, USB memory device and USB portable audio player or access the  
Internet Radio.  
Notes  
YAMAHA MCX-2000 may not be for sale in some locations.  
• For further details about networking, refer to the operation manuals supplied with your network devices. Also refer to technical  
reference books, if needed.  
• Some WAV, MP3 and WMA files may not be playable or may be noisy when played.  
y
• For a complete list of the remote control functions used to control the network and USB features, see the “PC/MCX-2000/Internet  
• For a complete list of status messages that appear in the front panel display and on the video monitor, see the “Network and USB”  
Navigating the network and USB menus  
The following diagram shows the construction of the network and USB menu.  
Selects a song by playlist stored on the server. Refer to the documents of  
the server for details about the playlist file format, the process of creating  
the playlist file, etc.  
NET/USB  
PC/MusicCAST  
(MCX-2000)  
Server*  
Playlists  
Artists  
Selects a song by artist. In addition, you can select an album within the  
artist (MCX-2000 only).  
Selects a song by album.  
Selects a song directly.  
Albums  
Songs  
Selects a song by genre. In addition, you can select an album within the  
genre (MCX-2000 only).  
Genres  
Makes this unit recall play from MCX-2000 or another client. For details,  
refer to the instruction manual of MCX-2000.  
Recall Play  
Selects an Internet Radio station that has been added to the “Bookmarks” list (see page 80).  
Selects an Internet Radio station or a Podcast service by location.  
Internet Radio  
Bookmarks  
Locations  
Genres  
Selects an Internet Radio station or a Podcast service by genre.  
Selects an Internet Radio station from the ones that have recently started the service.  
New Stations  
Selects an Internet Radio station from the list of popular stations.  
Selects a Podcast service by location or genre.  
Popular Stations  
Podcasts  
Broadcasts voice-assisted guidelines on various topics of the related Internet service.  
Selects a file by navigating directories.  
Help  
USB  
Files/Directories  
Note  
*
Only the available PC servers and MCX-2000 are displayed.  
77 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
The following procedure shows the basic steps to navigate  
the network and USB menus. See pages 79 and 80 for  
details about each sub input source.  
3
4
Press k/ nto select the desired sub input  
source and then press hor ENTER.  
y
Note  
You can also select the desired sub input source by pressing  
the corresponding button on the remote control (see page 8).  
“Please wait” may appear whenever it takes time for  
communication. This is not a system malfunction. Wait for a  
while.  
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press NET/USB on the remote  
control to select “NET/USB” as the input  
source.  
PC/MCX  
Press k/ n / l/ hon the remote control to  
select the desired song or Internet Radio  
station.  
• Press k/ nto select the desired menu.  
• Press hto enter the selected menu.  
• Press lto return to the previous menu level.  
The cursor on the left of the NET/USB indicator  
lights up in the front panel display, and the contents  
previously played for the corresponding sub input  
source of NET/USB is automatically played.  
AMP  
y
NET/USB  
SOURCE  
• “h” in the right corner of each menu line indicates that  
there is a submenu available in the next menu level.  
You can press ENTER or MENU to enter the selected  
menu or to return to the previous menu level.  
TV  
Lights up  
5
Press ENTER to play the selected song or to  
listen to the selected station.  
NET/USB V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
y
See page 76 for details about the functions of the play  
information display.  
• Some items do not appear in the play information display  
depending on the selected sub input source.  
2
Press DISPLAY on the remote control to  
display the top NET/USB menu.  
The following display appears on the video monitor.  
If any other screen appears on the video monitor,  
press MENU on the remote control repeatedly until  
the top NET/USB menu appears.  
Top  
PC/MusicCAST  
Internet Radio  
USB  
DISPLAY  
78 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
Installing Windows Media Connect 2.0  
on your PC  
With Windows Media Connect 2.0, you can play back the  
audio files on your PC. For details refer to the documents  
of Windows Media Connect 2.0.  
Using a PC server or YAMAHA  
MCX-2000  
Use this feature to enjoy music files saved on your PC or  
YAMAHA MCX-2000. MCX-2000 is a music server that  
enhances the concept of YAMAHA exclusive  
MusicCAST, a digital music delivery method over a  
personal network.  
1
Install Windows Media Connect 2.0 on your  
PC.  
You can download the installer of Windows Media  
Connect 2.0 from the Microsoft website.  
1
Install Windows Media Connect 2.0 on your  
PC, or register this unit on your YAMAHA  
MCX-2000.  
2
Turn on your PC and then share a folder on  
the PC.  
• Refer to “Installing Windows Media Connect 2.0  
on your PC” on page 79 and “Registering this unit  
on the YAMAHA MCX-2000” on page 80.  
• This procedure is needed only the first time.  
The Shared folder is added to the server list on the  
submenu of PC/MusicCAST.  
Notes  
• Some security software installed on your PC (anti-virus  
software, firewall software, etc.) may block the access of this  
unit to your PC. In such cases, configure the security software  
appropriately.  
• If you are using a PC with Windows XP Professional, and the  
PC is logging on to a domain, you may not be able to connect  
the PC server. In such cases, log on to the local machine instead  
of the domain.  
2
3
Turn on your PC or MCX-2000.  
The PC server or MCX-2000 is added to the server  
list on the submenu of PC/MusicCAST.  
Select a desired server or MusicCAST to  
begin playback.  
Notes  
YAMAHA MCX-2000 may not be for sale in some locations.  
You can connect this unit to up to 4 PC servers and 1  
MCX-2000, and each server must be connected to the same  
subnet as this unit.  
• Some WAV, MP3 and WMA files on your PC may not be  
playable or may be noisy when played.  
• (MCX-2000 only) Files marked with an asterisk (*) have not  
been converted to MP3 format. You cannot play back such files  
immediately unless you set the “Receive PCM Stream” setting  
of this unit to “ON” on MCX-2000. For details, refer to the  
instruction manual of MCX-2000.  
y
• While a song is being played, the time elapsed is displayed at  
the bottom of the playback information screen.  
You can use b/ ato skip backward/forward and h/ s  
to start/stop playback independently from the menu on the  
video monitor.  
You can set the settings for repeat and shuffle mode by using the  
“Play Style” parameters in “NET/USB” (see page 110).  
You can set whether to display the operation status in the front  
panel display in a continuous manner or by the first 14  
characters after scrolling all characters once by using “Scroll”  
in “Front Panel Disp.” (see page 112).  
79 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
Registering this unit on the YAMAHA  
MCX-2000  
You must register this unit on your YAMAHA MCX-2000  
so that this unit can be recognized by your YAMAHA  
MCX-2000. For details, refer to the operation manual  
supplied with your YAMAHA MCX-2000.  
Using the Internet Radio  
Use this feature to listen to Internet Radio stations. This  
unit uses the vTuner Internet Radio station database  
service particularly customized for this unit, providing  
over 2000 radio station database. Further, you can store  
your favorite stations with bookmarks.  
1
2
Turn off this unit.  
Notes  
Set your YAMAHA MCX-2000 to the “Auto  
Config” mode.  
• This service may be discontinued without notice.  
• Some Internet Radio stations may not be played even if they are  
selected in the NET RADIO menu.  
• To listen to the Internet Radio, connect this unit to your network  
• A narrowband Internet connection (i.e. 56K modem, ISDN) will  
not provide satisfactory results, and a broadband connection is  
strongly recommended (i.e. a cable modem, an xDSL modem,  
etc.). For detailed information, consult with your ISP.  
3
Turn on this unit.  
• MCX-2000 is added to the server list on the  
submenu of PC/MCX.  
• The client ID of this unit appears in the OSD of  
your YAMAHA MCX-2000 (shown as CL-  
XXXXX), and this completes the automatic  
configuration procedure.  
y
You can use h/ sto start/stop playback independently from  
the menu on the video monitor.  
Notes  
• “Podcast” is a type of the Internet Radio service, and there are a  
number of Podcast services available on the Internet. The  
Podcast is not a continuous service. That is, this unit stops  
playback when an episode of the Podcast ends.  
• Some security devices (such as firewall) may block the access  
of this unit to Internet Radio stations. In such cases, configure  
the security settings appropriately.  
• The latter part of the client ID of this unit is same as the last 5  
digits of the MAC address of this unit. For details about MAC  
• To clear the registered client ID of this unit, use the “Manual  
Config” mode of your YAMAHA MCX-2000 (refer to the  
instruction manual of MCX-2000) and then set “N-RESET” in  
the advanced setup menu of this unit to “RESET” (see  
• The client control functions of MusicCAST over this unit other  
than “View Play Info”, “Receive PCM Stream” and “Edit Client  
title” are not available. Avoid using these functions as it will  
stop the playback on this unit.  
Storing your favorite Internet Radio  
stations with bookmarks  
Use this feature to select your favorite Internet Radio  
stations quickly.  
Press and hold TITLE on the remote control while  
the selected Internet Radio station service is  
being broadcast.  
The stored Internet Radio station is added to the  
“Bookmarks” list (see page 77).  
y
To remove the stored station from the list, select the item in the  
first level of the “Bookmarks” list and then press and hold TITLE  
on the remote control.  
80 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
Using a USB memory device or a  
USB portable audio player  
Use this feature to enjoy WAV (PCM format only), MP3  
and WMA files saved on your USB memory device or  
USB portable audio player connected to the USB port on  
the front panel of this unit.  
Using shortcut buttons  
Use this feature to access the desired music sources (WAV,  
MP3 and WMA files on the connected PC, MCX-2000 or  
USB storage devices and Internet Radio stations) directly.  
You can preset 8 items in each sub input sources.  
Assigning the items to the numeric  
button (1-8)  
Notes  
• This unit supports USB mass storage class devices using FAT  
16 or FAT 32.  
• Only the first partition is displayed in the GUI menu. You  
cannot select files in other partitions.  
• Up to 8 levels of directory hierarchy and 500 music files per  
directory are recognized.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press NET/USB on the remote  
control to select “NET/USB” as the input  
source.  
AMP  
• Some devices may not work properly even if they meet the  
requirements.  
NET/USB  
SOURCE  
• Some WAV, MP3 and WMA files may not be playable or may  
be noisy when played.  
TV  
• When you connect your USB memory device or USB portable  
audio player, there may be an about 10 seconds delay.  
2
3
Select a desired music source you want to  
assign to the numeric button (1-8), and then  
play back the source.  
y
• While a song is being played, the time elapsed is displayed at  
the bottom of the playback information screen.  
You can use b/ ato skip backward/forward and h/ s  
to start/stop playback independently from the menu in the OSD.  
You can set the settings for repeat and shuffle mode by using the  
“Play Style” parameters in “NET/USB” (see page 110).  
You can set whether to display the operation status in the front  
panel display in a continuous manner or by the first 14  
characters after scrolling all characters once by using “Scroll”  
in “Front Panel Disp.” (see page 112).  
See page 78 for details.  
Press MEMORY.  
This unit in the memory preset mode. The MEMORY  
indicator flashes and following message appears in  
the video monitor and front panel display.  
RETURN  
Connecting a USB memory device or a  
MEMORY  
USB potable audio player  
Connect a USB jack of a USB memory device or  
USB portable audio player to the USB port on the  
front panel of this unit.  
MEMORY  
ꢀ-:ꢀPC/MCX  
Preset number  
Flashes  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
S
y
When you do not complete each of the following steps within 5  
seconds, the memory preset mode is automatically canceled. In  
this case, start over from step 3.  
USB  
USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player  
81 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
USING NETWORK/USB FEATURES  
4
Press desired numeric buttons (1-8).  
The number of the selected numeric button appears in  
the video monitor or front panel display.  
3
Press one of the numeric button (1-8) which  
the desired item is assigned to select the  
item as the input source.  
The selected preset number appears in the front panel  
display, and this unit starts the playback of the source  
assigned to the selected numeric button.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
8
5
6
7
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
8
5
6
7
NET/USB V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
MEMORY  
ꢀ1:ꢀPC/MCX  
NET/USB V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
Selected preset number  
Flashes  
ꢀ1:ꢀPC/MCX  
Selected preset number  
5
Press ENTER or MEMORY to confirm the  
preset.  
Notes  
PRESET/CH  
• “Empty Memory!” appears in the front panel display and  
the short message display when you press the numeric  
button (1-8) to which no items are assigned.  
RETURN  
or  
ENTER  
MEMORY  
• This unit does not recall the correct item assigned to the  
selected numeric button (1-8) in the following cases:  
– the connected USB device is incorrect.  
A/B/C/D/E  
– the PC or MCX-2000 which stores the selected item is  
turned off or disconnected from the network.  
– the selected Internet Radio station is temporary  
unavailable or out of service.  
Select an item by using numeric buttons  
(1-8)  
– the directory of the selected item has been changed.  
y
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press NET/USB on the remote  
control to select “NET/USB” as the input  
source.  
This unit stores the relative position of the preset items in a  
directory or playlist, and does not recall the correct item by  
using numeric buttons (1-8) if you add or delete music files  
to or from the same directory or playlist as the preset items.  
In such cases, preset the desired item to the numeric buttons  
(1-8) again.  
AMP  
We recommend the following methods:  
NET/USB  
SOURCE  
PC server/MCX-2000  
TV  
Create eight playlists which contain desired items, and then  
preset the top item of each playlist to the numeric buttons  
(1-8). When you change the items which are preset to the  
numeric buttons (1-8), replace the registered items in the  
playlist with the desired items without deleting the playlist.  
2
Select the desired sub input source.  
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
USB devices  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
Create eight directories which contain desired items in a  
directory beside the directory which contains all music files,  
and then preset the top item of each directory to the numeric  
buttons (1-8). When you change the items which are preset  
to the numeric buttons (1-8), replace the items in the  
directory to the desired items without deleting the directory.  
PC/MCX  
82 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RECORDING  
RECORDING  
Recording adjustments and other operations are performed from the recording components. Refer to the operating  
instructions for those components.  
CAUTION  
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in  
noise being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to record sources encoded in DTS, the  
following considerations and adjustments need to be made. To play DTS-encoded DVDs and CDs  
(when using a digital audio connection) on your DTS-compatible player, follow its operating  
instructions to make a setting so that the analog signal will be output from the player.  
Notes  
• When this unit is set to the standby mode, you cannot record between other components connected to this unit.  
• The settings of TONE CONTROL (see page 52), VOLUME, the speaker level (see page 109) and the sound field programs (see  
page 47) do not affect recorded material.  
• The source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit cannot be recorded.  
• The XM Satellite Radio signals (U.S.A. and Canada models only) cannot be output at the AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.  
• Digital signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT jacks are not output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording. Likewise,  
analog signals input at the AUDIO IN jacks are not output at the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. Therefore, if your source component is  
connected to provide only digital or analog signals, you can only record digital or analog signals.  
• A given input source is not output on the same OUT (REC) channel.  
• S-video and composite video signals pass independently through the video circuits of this unit. Therefore, when recording or dubbing  
video signals input from a video source component that provides only an S-video or a composite video signal, you can record only an  
S-video or a composite video signal on your VCR.  
• The analog audio signals input at the DOCK terminal can be output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.  
• Check the copyright laws in your country to record from CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may infringe copyright  
laws.  
y
Do a test recording before you start an actual recording.  
If you play back a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture  
itself may be disturbed due to those signals.  
(U.S.A. model)  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select the source component you  
want to record from.  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
Select “SOURCE” to record the currently selected  
input source.  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
PROGRAM  
3 2  
Front panel  
1
2
Turn on all the connected components.  
4
5
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
Press REC OUT/ZONE 2 repeatedly until the  
RECOUT indicator lights up in the front panel  
display.  
Start recording on the recording component.  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2  
RECOUT  
83 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Selecting decoders  
2
Press SELECT on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the desired decoder.  
You can select from the following modes depending  
on the type of source you are playing and your  
personal preference.  
Selecting decoders for 2-channel  
sources (surround decode mode)  
Use this feature to play back sources with selected  
decoders. You can play back 2-channel sources on multi-  
channels.  
SELECT  
7
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SUR. DECODE on the remote  
control to select the surround decode mode.  
y
You can select the desired decoder by pressing SELECT  
and then press l/ hrepeatedly on the remote control.  
You can select the desired decoder and adjust the decoder  
parameter settings by using GUI screen. See page 88 for  
details.  
AMP  
SUR. DECODE  
SOURCE  
6
TV  
Decoder descriptions  
Name of the  
decoder  
(Decoder Type)  
Remote control  
button  
Category of the  
program  
SUR.DECODE  
PLꢀIIxꢀMusic  
PLꢀIIꢀMusic  
SUR. DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for music sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not  
available when “Surround Back” is set to “None” (see page 106).  
Panorama  
Dimension  
Center Width  
Program description  
Available sound field parameters (see page 89)  
SUR.DECODE  
SUR. DECODE  
PRO LOGIC  
6
Dolby Pro Logic processing for any sources.  
SUR.DECODE  
PLIIx Movie  
PL II Movie  
SUR. DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for movie sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “Surround  
Back” is set to “None” (see page 106).  
SUR.DECODE  
PLIIx Music  
PL II Music  
SUR. DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for music sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “Surround  
Back” is set to “None” (see page 106).  
Panorama  
Dimension  
Center Width  
84 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
PLIIx Game  
PL II Game  
SUR.DECODE  
SUR. DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for game sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “Surround  
Back” is set to “None” (see page 106).  
SUR.DECODE  
SUR. DECODE  
Neo: 6 Cinema  
6
DTS processing for movie sources.  
SUR.DECODE  
SUR. DECODE  
Neo:6 Music  
6
DTS processing for music sources.  
Center Image  
neural sur.  
(U.S.A. and Canada  
models only)  
SUR.DECODE  
SUR. DECODE  
6
Neural Surround processing for any sources.  
The Neural Surround decoder is compatible with PCM signals (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz and 96 kHz) and analog 2-  
channel input sources. When Neural Surround-incompatible signals are being input while the Neural Surround decoder is selected, multi-  
channel sources are decoded straight into the appropriate channels without any additional effect processing and the Neural Surround-  
incompatible PCM signals are played back in stereo. The Neural Surround decoder is especially suitable for the XM HD Surround program of  
XM Satellite Radio.  
y
When you select the surround decode mode for Dolby Digital, DTS or DTS 96/24 sources, this unit automatically selects “SURROUND  
DECODE Dolby Digital”, “SURROUND DECODE DTS” or “SURROUND DECODE DTS 96/24” program.  
Selecting decoders used with sound field programs  
Use this feature to select the desired decoder used with  
MOVIE sound field programs (except “Mono Movie”).  
See page 49 for details about MOVIE sound field  
program.  
Available decoders (Decoder Type)  
Decoder  
Functions  
Dolby Pro Logic processing for  
any sources  
PRO LOGIC  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press MOVIE on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the desired MOVIE  
sound field programs.  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby  
Pro Logic II) processing for  
movie sources. The Pro Logic IIx  
decoder is not available when  
“Surround Back” is set to “None”  
(see page 106).  
PLIIx Movie  
PLII Movie  
AMP  
MOVIE  
SOURCE  
DTS processing for movie  
sources  
4
Neo:6 Cinema  
TV  
2
Press SELECT repeatedly to select the  
desired decoder used with the selected  
sound field program.  
You can select from the following decoders  
depending on the type of source you are playing and  
your personal preference.  
y
You can select the desired decoder by pressing SELECT  
and then press l/ hrepeatedly on the remote control.  
You can also select decoders used with sound field  
programs by using GUI screen. Set “Decoder Type” in  
Stereo/Surround” to the desired setting (see page 88).  
85 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Decoders  
Selecting decoders for multi-channel  
sources  
If you connected surround back speakers, use this feature  
to enjoy 6.1/7.1-channel playback for multi-channel  
sources using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx, Dolby Digital EX  
or DTS-ES decoders.  
You can select from the following decoders depending on  
the format of the source you are playing.  
Decoder  
Functions  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 7.1 channels using  
the Pro Logic IIx movie  
decoder.  
PLIIxMovie  
q D+PLIIx Movie  
DTS+PLIIx Movie  
MPCM+PLIIx Movie  
DSD+PLIIx Movie  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press EXTD SUR. on the remote control  
repeatedly to switch between 5.1 and 6.1/7.1-  
channel playback.  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 6.1/7.1 channels  
using the Pro Logic IIx music  
decoder.  
PLIIxMusic  
AMP  
q D+PLIIx Music  
DTS+PLIIx Music  
MPCM+PLIIx Music  
DSD+PLIIx Music  
EXTD SUR.  
SOURCE  
8
TV  
Plays back DTS signals in 6.1/  
7.1 channels using the DTS-ES  
decoder.  
DTS ES  
DTS 96/24 ES  
2
Press l/ hrepeatedly to select a decoder  
while the name of the decoder is displayed.  
PRESET/CH  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 6.1/7.1 channels  
using the Dolby Digital EX  
decoder.  
DOLBY D EX  
DTS+DOLBY EX  
MPCM+DOLBY EX  
DSD+DOLBY EX  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Off OFF  
Decoders are not used to create 6.1/7.1 channels.  
Auto AUTO  
Notes  
When a signal flag that can be recognized by this unit is  
input, this unit selects the optimum decoder to play back  
the signal in 6.1/7.1 channels.  
• “PLIIx Movie” is available only when “Surround Back” (see  
page 106) is set to “Small x2” or “Large x2”.  
If this unit cannot recognize the flag or no flag is present  
in the input signal, it cannot automatically be played in  
6.1/7.1 channels.  
• Some 6.1/7.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal flag  
that can be automatically detected by this unit. When playing  
these kinds of discs in 6.1/7.1 channels, select a decoder  
manually from “PLIIx Music”, “EX/ES” or “EX”.  
• 6.1/7.1-channel playback is not possible even if you press  
EXTD SUR. in the following cases:  
– when “Surround” (see page 106) or “Surround Back” (see  
page 106) is set to “None”.  
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks is being played.  
– when the source being played does not contain surround left  
and right channel signals.  
– when a Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played.  
– when the “2ch Stereo” (see page 53) or Pure Direct (see  
page 52) mode is selected.  
• When this unit is turned off, this setting will be reset to “Auto”.  
• The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “Surround  
Back” is set to “None” (see page 106).  
86 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
This unit features a sophisticated graphical user interface (GUI) screen that helps you to control the amplifier function of  
this unit. With the GUI screen, you can view the information of the signals being input and the status of this unit.  
Sound  
Video  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
System Memory  
Stereo/Surround (Stereo/Surround menu)  
Use this feature to select the sound field programs and customize the program parameter settings (see page 88).  
Input Select (Input select menu)  
Use this feature to select the input source and customize the parameters of each input source.  
Manual Setup (Manual setup menu)  
Use this feature to manually adjust speaker and system parameters (see page 97).  
Sound (Sound menu)  
Use this menu to manually adjust any speaker settings, alter the quality and tone of the sound output by the system or  
compensate for video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors or projectors (see page 97).  
Video (Video menu)  
Use this feature to manually adjust the video parameters (see page 101).  
Basic (Basic menu)  
Use this feature to manually adjust the basic speaker parameters (see page 104).  
NET/USB (Network and USB menu)  
Use this menu to manually adjust the network and USB system parameters (see page 109).  
Option (Option menu)  
Use this feature to manually adjust the optional system parameters (see page 111).  
Auto Setup (Auto setup menu)  
Use this menu to run Auto Setup and specify which speaker parameters to be adjusted (see page 35).  
System Memory (System memory menu)  
Use this feature to store and recall various settings of this unit (see page 115).  
Signal Info. (Signal information)  
Use this feature to check audio signal information (see page 116).  
Language (GUI language menu)  
Use this feature to select the language of your choice that appears in the GUI screen of this unit (see page 117).  
y
You can also select the GUI language using “GUI LANGUAGE” parameter in “ADVANCED SETUP” in the front panel display (see  
See page 44 for details about the operations in GUI screen.  
87 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Stereo/Surround  
(Stereo/Surround menu)  
4
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select the desired  
programs.  
PRESET/CH  
Use this feature to select the sound field programs (see  
page 46), the surround decode mode, the “STRAIGHT”  
mode (See page 51) or the Compressed Music Enhancer  
mode (See page 54), and adjust the parameters of each  
program.  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Selecting sound field programs and  
setting the parameters by using GUI  
screen  
5
Press hon the remote control and then k/ n  
to select the desired parameter.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
1
2
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
ENTER  
AMP  
ENTER  
SET MENU  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
y
You can select “Initialize” to set all the parameters of the selected  
sound field program to the default values. See page 93 for details.  
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control to  
select “Stereo/Surround” and then press h.  
6
Press hand then press l/ hto adjust the  
selected parameter.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Dimmer  
Input Assign  
Support Audio  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
7
Press ENTER or k/ nto confirm the setting  
of the selected parameter.  
CLASSICAL  
LIVE/CLUB  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Manual Setup  
or  
ENTER  
ENTER  
3
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select the desired  
category of the programs and then press h.  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
88 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Sound field parameter descriptions  
You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so that the sound fields are recreated accurately in your  
listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program.  
Sound field parameter  
Decoder Type  
Features  
Decoder type. Selects the decoder used with the SUR. DECODE or MOVIE programs. See  
pages 84 and 85 for details.  
DSP level. Adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range. Depending on  
the acoustics of your listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP effect level  
relative to the level of the direct sound.  
DSP Level  
Control range: –6 dB to +3 dB  
Initial delay. Presence, surround, and surround back initial delay. Changes the apparent distance  
from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection  
heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The  
larger the value, the farther it seems. For a small room, set to a small value. For a large room, set  
to a large value.  
Init. Delay  
Sur. Init. Delay  
SB Init. Delay  
Control range: 1 to 99 ms (Init. Delay)  
1 to 49 ms (Sur. Init. Delay and SB Init. Delay)  
Source sound  
Early  
reflections  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Delay  
Delay  
Delay  
Sound source  
Reflection face  
Small value = 1 ms  
Large value = 99 ms  
89 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
Room size. Presence, surround, and surround back room size. Adjusts the apparent size of the  
surround sound field. The larger the value, the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the  
sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between  
the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the  
reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter  
from one to two doubles the apparent length of the room.  
Room Size  
Sur. Room Size  
SB Room Size  
Control range: 0.1 to 2.0  
Source sound  
Early  
reflections  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Sound source  
Small value = 0.1  
Large value = 2.0  
Liveness. Surround and surround back liveness. Adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual walls in the  
hall by changing the rate at which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of a sound  
source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall surfaces than in one which  
has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to as  
“dead”, while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live”. This parameter lets  
you adjust the early reflection decay rate and thus the “liveness” of the room.  
Liveness  
Sur. Liveness  
SB Liveness  
Control range: 0 to 10  
Source sound  
Live  
Dead  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Small reflected  
sound  
Large reflected  
sound  
Small value = 0  
Large value = 10  
90 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Sound field parameter  
Rev. Time  
Features  
Reverberation time. Adjusts the amount of time taken for the dense, subsequent reverberation  
sound to decay by 60 dB at 1 kHz. This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment  
over an extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time for “dead” sources and listening  
room environments, and a shorter time for “live” sources and listening room environments.  
Control range: 1.0 to 5.0 s  
Reverberation  
Source sound  
Reverberation  
Early reflections  
60 dB  
60 dB  
60 dB  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Time  
Rev. Time  
Sound source  
Short  
reverberation  
Long  
reverberation  
Small value = 1.0 s  
Large value = 5.0 s  
Reverberation delay. Adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and  
the beginning of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound  
begins. A later reverberation sound makes you feel as if you are in a larger acoustic environment.  
Rev. Delay  
Control range: 0 to 250 ms  
Source sound  
(dB)  
60 dB  
Reverberation  
Time  
Rev. Delay  
Rev. Time  
91 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
Reverberation level. Adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the  
stronger the reverberation becomes.  
Rev. Level  
Control range: 0 to 100%  
Source sound  
Rev. Level  
Time  
Dialogue lift. Adjusts the height of the front and center channel sounds by assigning some of the  
front and center channel elements to the presence speakers. The larger the parameter, the higher  
the position of the front and center channel sound.  
Dialogue Lift  
Choices: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5  
Stereo program parameter descriptions  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
2-channel stereo direct. Bypasses the decoders and DSP processors of this unit for pure hi-fi stereo  
sound when playing 2-channel analog sources.  
2ch Stereo  
Direct  
Choices: Auto, Off  
y
• Select “Auto” to bypass the decoders, DSP processors and the tone control circuitry only when  
“BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB (see page 52).  
• Select “Off” not to bypass the decoders, DSP processors and the tone control circuitry when  
“BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB.  
• When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are input, they are downmixed to 2  
channels and output from the front left and right speakers.  
• The low-frequency signals input from the front left and right speakers are redirected to the  
subwoofer in the following cases:  
– “Bass Out” is set to “Both” (see page 107).  
– “Front” is set to “Small” (see page 105) and “Bass Out” is set to “SWFR” (see page 107).  
7-channel stereo center, surround left, surround right, surround back, presence left and presence right  
levels. Adjusts the volume level of each channel in the 7-channel stereo mode.  
7ch Stereo  
Center Level  
Surround L Level  
Surround R Level  
Sur. Back Level  
Presence L Level  
Presence R Level  
Control range: 0 to 100%  
92 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
The Compressed Music Enhancer mode parameter descriptions  
The Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode  
Features  
2-channel enhancer or 7-channel enhancer effect level. Select “High” or “Low” to adjust the effect for  
the high-frequency.  
2ch Enhancer  
7ch Enhancer  
Choices: High, Low  
Decoder parameter descriptions  
Decoder parameter  
Features  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music panorama. Sends stereo signals to the surround speakers as  
well as the front speakers for a wraparound effect.  
Pro Logic IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
Panorama  
Choices: Off, On  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music dimension. Adjusts the sound field either towards the front  
or towards the rear.  
PRO LOGIC IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
Dimension  
Control range: –3 (towards the rear) to +3 (towards the front)  
Initial setting: STD (standard)  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music center width. Moves the center channel output completely  
towards the center speaker or towards the front left and right speakers. A larger value moves the center  
channel output towards the front left and right speakers.  
PRO LOGIC IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
Center Width  
Control range: 0 (center channel sound is output only from the center speaker) to  
7 (center channel sound is output only from the front left and right speakers)  
Initial setting: 3  
DTS Neo:6 Music center image. Adjusts the front left and right channel output relative to the center  
channel to make the center channel more or less dominant as necessary.  
DTS Neo:6 Music  
Center Image  
Control range: 0.0 to 1.0  
Initial setting: 0.3  
Initialize (Program parameters initialization)  
Use this feature to initialize the parameter of the selected sound field program.  
Choices: No, Yes  
SB Room Size  
Dialogue Lift  
Initialize  
No  
Yes  
Select “Yes” to set the program parameters to the factory default settings.  
Select “No” to cancel the program parameter initialization.  
y
Use the “Sur. Initialize” feature in “Option” to initialize the parameters of each sound field program within a sound field program group  
(see page 114).  
93 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Input Select  
Use this feature to reassign digital input/outputs, select the  
input signal, rename the inputs, or adjust the level of the  
signal input at each input source.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
The top display appears.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
Input source  
Parameter  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
XM  
(U.S.A. and Canada models  
only)  
Antenna Level  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Sound  
Video  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
TUNER  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
PHONO  
CD  
CD-R  
MD/TAPE  
DVD  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
VCR1  
DVR/VCR2  
NET/USB  
Option  
I/O Assignment  
Audio Select  
Decoder Mode  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
System Memory  
2
3
Select “Input Select” and then press h.  
CD-R  
I/O Assignment*  
Audio Select*  
Decoder Mode*  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
MD/TAPE  
DVD  
V-AUX or DOCK  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
PC/MCX, NET RADIO or  
USB  
Volume Trim  
Select the desired input source (CD, DVD,  
etc.) and then press hor ENTER to access  
and adjust.  
I/O Assignment  
Audio Select  
Decoder Mode  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
MULTI CH  
Antenna Level (Antenna level)  
Use this feature to check the current reception level of the  
XM Passport System connected to the XM jack of this  
unit (see page 63). For the best reception, orient the XM  
Passport System so that a value of 60% or more is  
displayed here.  
Multi CH Assign  
BGV  
Notes  
• Some parameters described above may not be available for all  
input sources and some parameters are only available for  
specific input sources.  
Display status: None, 0 to 100%  
• When iPod is stationed in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock  
(such as YDS-10, sold separately) connected to the DOCK  
terminal of this unit, “DOCK” appears in the “Input Select”  
menu instead of “V-AUX”. In such cases, the parameters  
marked with asterisk (*) in the above table does not appears in  
the input source parameter menu.  
• When you select “NET/USB” as the input source, selected sub  
input source (PC/MCX, NET RADIO or USB) appears in the  
Input Select menu.  
Antenna Level  
Antenna Level  
100%  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Notes  
• “None” is displayed if the XM Passport System is not connected to  
this unit. In this case, check the antenna connections (see page 63).  
• The “Antenna Level” parameter cannot be adjusted by using the  
remote control. Instead, you need to adjust the orientation of the  
XM Passport System connected to the XM jack of this unit for a  
better percentage of the reception level.  
94 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Volume Trim (Volume trimming)  
Use this feature to adjust the level of the signal input at  
each input source. This is useful if you want to balance the  
level of each input source to avoid sudden changes in  
volume when switching between input sources.  
Control range: –6.0 dB to +6.0 dB  
3
Press k/ nto select the character you want  
to use and l / hto move to the next one.  
You can use up to 8 characters for each input.  
• Press nto change the character in the following  
order, or press kto go in the reverse order:  
CAPITAL A to Z, space  
Initial setting: 0.0 dB  
SMALL a to z, space  
FIGURE 0 to 9, space  
Audio Select  
MARK  
!, #, %, &, etc.  
Decoder Mode  
• Press ENTER to switch between character types.  
• Repeat steps 1 to 3 to rename each input.  
0.0dB  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Note  
Even if you select “Français”, “Deutsch”, Espaсol” or  
Русский” in “Language” (see page 117), you cannot use  
accent symbols or cyrillic alphabets for the name of each  
input.  
y
This parameter also affects the signals output at ZONE OUT  
jacks.  
Note  
4
Press l / hto select OK and press ENTER  
when complete.  
You can only adjust the volume for the current input source  
using this setting.  
y
Rename (Rename)  
• Select “RESET” to set the name of the selected input to default.  
• This feature is useful when you change the input or output  
assignment for digital jacks and component video input jacks.  
You can also change the name of the input source that appears  
in the display window on the remote control. Refer to  
Use this feature to change the name of the inputs in the  
GUI screen or the front panel display menu. (DVD is used  
as the source component in the following example.)  
1
2
Press l / hto place the _ (under-bar) under  
the space or character you want to edit.  
Note  
You can only change the name of the current input source  
(except for multi channel input sources) using this setting.  
Decoder Mode  
CAPITAL  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
DVD  
OK  
RESET  
Press ENTER repeatedly to select a character  
type (CAPITAL/SMALL/FIGURE/MARK).  
95 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
I/O Assignment  
Audio Select (Audio input jack select)  
This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. You can  
select the type of input signal you want to use.  
Choices: Auto, HDMI, Coax/Opt, Analog  
(Input/output assignment)  
Use this feature to assign the input/output jacks according  
to the component to be used if the initial settings of this  
unit do not correspond to your needs. Change the  
following parameters to reassign the respective jacks and  
effectively connect more components.  
I/O Assignment  
Once the input/output jacks are reassigned, you can select  
the corresponding component by using the INPUT  
selector on the front panel (or the input selector buttons on  
the remote control).  
Audio Select  
Decoder Mode  
Volume Trim  
Auto  
HDMI  
Coax/Opt  
Select “Auto” when you want signals to be input to this  
unit in the following order: HDMI signals, digital  
signals and analog signals.  
Select “HDMI” when you only want HDMI signals to  
be input to this unit. If no HDMI signals are input, no  
sound is output.  
Select “Coax/Opt” when you want digital signals to be  
input to this unit at the OPTICAL or COAXIAL jacks.  
Use if HDMI signals are also being input.  
Select “Analog” when you only want analog signals to  
be input to this unit. If no analog signals are input, no  
sound is output.  
Optical Output  
Component Video  
I/O Assignment  
Audio Select  
HDMI  
Decoder Mode  
Example 1: Assigning the COAXIAL 1 CD jack to  
the DVD input.  
1
2
3
Select “Input Select” in the GUI screen and  
then select “DVD”.  
y
You can also select the audio input jack by pressing AUDIO  
SELECT on the front panel (or AUDIO SEL on the remote  
control). See page 42 for details.  
You can set the default Audio input jack select of this unit by  
using “Audio Select” in “Option” (see page 114).  
Select “I/O Assignment” and then “Coaxial  
Input”.  
Select “1 CD”.  
Note  
Example 2: Clearing a jack assignment.  
This feature is not available when no digital input jack  
(OPTICAL, COAXIAL and HDMI) are assigned. In addition,  
“HDMI” is not available as an Audio input jack select setting  
when the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 and HDMI IN 3 jacks are not  
used. Use “I/O Assignment” in “Input Select” to reassign the  
respective input jack (see page 96).  
1
2
Select “Input Select” and then select the  
desired input source (“DVD”, etc.).  
Select “I/O Assignment” and then select the  
desired jack assignment (“Coaxial Input”,  
“Optical Input”, “Optical Output”,  
Decoder Mode (Decoder mode)  
Use this feature to switch the input mode. You can  
designate the reassigned digital input jacks (see page 96)  
for specific audio signals (DTS, etc.).  
“Component Video”, or “HDMI”).  
Choices: Auto, DTS  
3
Select “None” and then press ENTER to clear  
the assignment.  
I/O Assignment  
Audio Select  
Notes  
Decoder Mode  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Auto  
DTS  
You cannot select a specific item more than once for the same  
type of jack.  
• When you connect a component to both the COAXIAL and  
OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to signals input at the  
COAXIAL jack.  
Select “Auto” if you want this unit to automatically  
detect input signal types and select the appropriate  
input mode.  
Select “DTS” if you want this unit to select DTS as the  
input mode.  
96 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Multi CH Assign  
Manual Setup (Sound)  
Use this menu to adjust the sound parameters.  
(Multi channel assignment)  
Use this feature to set the direction of the signals input  
into the center, subwoofer and surround channels when a  
source component is connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks. If you input 8-channel signals from an external  
decoder, use this feature to select jacks for the additional  
front signals.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Volume Trim  
Rename  
Multi CH Assign  
BGV  
Input Channels  
Front Input  
2
Press k/ non the remote control to select  
“Manual Setup” and then press h.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Input Channels (Input channels)  
This setting is used to select the number of channels input  
from an external decoder.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Choices: 6ch, 8ch  
Note  
If “Zone2 Amplifier” (page 113) is set to “INT:[SP1]”,  
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control to  
select “Sound” and then press h.  
“INT:[SP2]” or “INT:Both”, no sound is output from the surround  
back speakers even if you select “8ch”. In this case, select “6ch”  
and set the output setting of the external component to 6 channels.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Front Input (Front input)  
If you selected “8ch” in Input Channels, you can select  
analog jacks at which front signals from an external  
decoder will be input.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Choices: DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR1, DVR/VCR2,  
V-AUX, CD, CD-R, MD/TAPE  
BGV (Back ground video)  
Use this feature to select the video source played in the  
background of the sources input from the MULTI CH  
INPUT jacks.  
LFE Level  
Dynamic Range  
Parametric EQ  
Tone Control  
Sound  
Video  
Basic  
Audio Option  
DVR/VCR 2  
V-AUX  
Last  
Rename  
Multi CH Assign  
BGV  
4
Select the desired parameters and then press  
hto access and adjust.  
Off  
PRESET/CH  
Choices: DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
V-AUX, Last, Off  
ENTER  
Select “Last” to set this unit to automatically select the  
last selected video source as the background video  
source.  
A/B/C/D/E  
Select “Off” to set this unit not to play the video source  
in the background.  
97 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
LFE Level (Low-frequency effect level)  
Use this feature to adjust the output level of the  
LFE (low-frequency effect) channel according to the  
capacity of your subwoofer or headphones. The LFE  
channel carries low-frequency special effects which are  
only added to certain scenes. This setting is effective only  
when this unit decodes Dolby Digital or DTS signals.  
Control range: –20.0 to 0.0 dB  
Parametric EQ (Parametric equalizer)  
Use this feature to adjust the parametric equalizer of each  
speaker.  
LFE Level  
Dynamic Range  
Parametric EQ  
Tone Control  
Audio Option  
Test Tone  
Front L  
Control step: 1.0 dB  
Front R  
0.0dB  
Speaker  
1
Press k/ n/ l/ hto select Test Tone or the  
speaker you want to adjust.  
Headphone  
• Select “Test Tone” to choose whether turns on or  
off the test tone output when adjusting the tonal  
quality of each speaker.  
• Select “Front L” to adjust the tonal quality of the  
front left speaker.  
Speaker (Speaker low-frequency effect level)  
Select to adjust the speaker LFE level.  
Headphone (Headphone low-frequency effect  
level)  
Select to adjust the headphone LFE level.  
• Select “Front R” to adjust the tonal quality of the  
front right speaker.  
• Select “Center” to adjust the tonal quality of the  
center speaker.  
• Select “Surround L” to adjust the tonal quality of  
the surround left speaker.  
Note  
Depending on the settings of “LFE Level, some signals may not  
be output at the SUBWOOFER jack.  
• Select “Surround R” to adjust the tonal quality of  
the surround right speaker.  
Dynamic Range (Dynamic range)  
Use this feature to select the amount of dynamic range  
compression to be applied to your speakers or  
headphones. This setting is effective only when the unit is  
decoding Dolby Digital and DTS signals.  
Choices: MAX (maximum), STD (standard),  
MIN (minimum)  
• Select “Surround Back L” to adjust the tonal  
quality of the surround back left speaker.  
• Select “Surround Back R” to adjust the tonal  
quality of the surround back right speaker.  
• Select “Presence L” to adjust the tonal quality of  
the presence left speaker.  
• Select “Presence R” to adjust the tonal quality of  
the presence right speaker.  
• Select “Subwoofer” to adjust the tonal quality of  
the subwoofer.  
MAX  
STD  
MIN  
Speaker  
2
3
Press hto access the settings window.  
Headphone  
PARAM  
RESET  
EXIT  
EDIT  
Test Tone  
Front L  
Front R  
Center  
Band / Gain  
Speaker (Speaker dynamic range)  
Select to adjust the speaker compression.  
Headphone (Headphone dynamic range)  
Select to adjust the headphone compression.  
Select “MAX” to preserve the greatest amount of  
dynamic range.  
Select “STD” for general use.  
Select “MIN” for listening to sources at low volume  
levels.  
Press k/ n/ l/ hto select “PARAM” and  
then press ENTER to select a parameter from  
“Band” (band), “Freq.” (frequency) or “Q” (Q  
factor).  
y
You cam adjust the gain with any parameter.  
98 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Control (Tone control)  
Choices: Speakers, Headphones  
4
Press nto select “EDIT” and press ENTER to  
access the edit window.  
Band  
Gain  
Freq.  
Q
#1  
0.0dB  
125.0Hz  
1.000  
Test Tone  
Front L  
Front R  
Center  
Control  
Bass  
Speakers  
Headphones  
Treble  
Select “Speakers” to adjust the bass/treble balance of  
your speakers.  
Select “Headphones” to adjust the bass/treble balance  
of your headphones.  
The parameter selected in “PARAM” is highlighted.  
• Press l/ hto adjust the parameter.  
• Press k/ nto adjust the “Gain”.  
• Press ENTER to exit the edit window.  
y
“Speaker” and “Headphone” adjustments are stored  
independently. The adjustments for “Speaker” affects the  
front left/right, center, presence left/right speaker channels  
and Subwoofer channel.  
y
• When you select “Band” in step 3, you can use this menu  
as a graphic equalizer.  
• The “Band #1” and “Band #2” can adjust the frequencies  
below of 198.4 Hz.  
• When you select “Subwoofer” in step 1 and “Band” in  
step 3, you can adjust “Band #1” and “Band #2” only.  
• For more information on the parametric equalizer, see  
page 98.  
Bass (Bass control)  
Use this feature to adjust low-frequencies output to your  
speakers or headphones.  
Choices: 125Hz, 350Hz, 500Hz  
Control range: – 6.0 dB to +6.0 dB  
Initial setting: 0.0 dB  
5
6
Repeat steps 3 and 4 until you are satisfied  
with the results.  
Speaker  
Freq : 350Hz  
Gain : 0.0dB  
y
Control  
Bass  
If you want to reset all “Parametric EQ” parameter settings  
for the selected speaker, select “RESET” and press ENTER.  
+6  
+0  
-6  
Treble  
Audio Bypass  
Select “EXIT” and press ENTER to exit the  
settings window.  
Tone Control (Tone control)  
Use this feature to adjust the balance of bass and treble  
output to your speakers or headphones.  
Treble (Treble control)  
Use this feature to adjust high-frequencies output to your  
speakers or headphones.  
Choices: 2.5kHz, 3.5kHz, 8.0kHz  
Control range: – 6.0 dB to +6.0 dB  
Initial setting: 0.0 dB  
Choices: Control, Bass, Treble, Audio Bypass  
Note  
Tone Control is not effective when:  
– PURE DIRECT (see page 52) is selected.  
– MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input source.  
Speaker  
Freq : 3.5kHz  
Gain : 0.0dB  
Control  
Bass  
+6  
+0  
-6  
Treble  
Auto Bypass  
99 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Auto Bypass (Auto bypass)  
Audio Delay (Audio delay)  
Use this feature to select whether the audio output  
bypasses the tone control circuitry when “TREBLE” and  
“BASS” are set to 0 dB (see page 52).  
Choices: Auto, Off  
Use this feature to delay the sound output and synchronize  
it with the video image. This may be necessary when  
using certain LCD monitors, projectors or high definition  
monitors.  
Control range: 0 to 240 ms  
Bass  
Treble  
Muting Type  
Auto Bypass  
Auto  
Off  
0ms  
Audio Delay  
Max Volume  
Initial Volume  
Select “AUTO” if you want the signals to bypass the  
tone control circuitry to provide the purest signal  
possible.  
Select “OFF” if you do not want the signals to bypass  
the tone control circuitry.  
Max Volume (Maximum volume)  
Use this feature to set the maximum volume level in the  
main zone. This feature is useful to avoid the unexpected  
laud sound by mistake. For example, the original volume  
range is 16.5 dB to –80.0 dB. However, when “Max  
Volume” is set to –5.0 dB, the volume range becomes  
–5.0 dB to –80.0 dB.  
Audio Option (Audio options)  
Use this feature to adjust the overall audio settings of this  
unit.  
Control range: 16.5 dB, 15.0 dB to –30.0 dB  
Control step: 5.0 dB  
Muting Type (Muting type)  
Use this feature to adjust how much the mute function  
reduces the output volume.  
Muting Type  
Audio Delay  
Choices: Full, –20dB  
+16.5dB  
Max Volume  
Initial Volume  
Full  
Muting Type  
-20dB  
Audio Delay  
Max Volume  
Notes  
• When a test tone is output, the “Max Volume” setting is  
automatically deactivated because the volume level is  
automatically set to 0 dB regardless of the current “Max  
Volume” setting.  
Select “Full” to completely mute all the audio output.  
Select “–20dB” to reduce the current volume by 20 dB.  
• The “Max Volume” setting takes priority over the “Initial  
Volume” setting (see page 100). For example, “Initial Volume”  
is set to –20.0 dB and then “Max Volume” is set to –30.0 dB,  
the volume level is automatically set to -30.0 dB when you turn  
on the power of this unit next time.  
Initial Volume (Initial volume)  
Use this feature to set the volume level of the main zone  
when the power of this unit is turned on.  
Choices: Off, –80 dB to +16.5 dB  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Audio Delay  
Max Volume  
Off  
Initial Volume  
100 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Note  
Manual Setup (Video)  
Use this menu to adjust the video parameters.  
The “Max Volume” setting takes priority over the “Initial  
Volume” setting. Therefore, Initial Volume cannot be set beyond  
the existing “Max Volume” setting.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
Channel Mute (Channel mute)  
Use this feature to mute specific speaker channels.  
AMP  
Mode (Mode)  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the “Channel  
Mute” setting for each speaker.  
Choices: Off, On  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
2
Press k/ non the remote control to select  
“Manual Setup” and then press h.  
Presence R  
Subwoofer  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Mode  
Off  
On  
Front L  
Front R  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Select “Off” to deactivate the “Channel Mute” settings.  
Select “On” to activate the “Channel Mute” settings.  
Each speaker settings  
Choices: Mute, Off  
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control to  
select “Video” and then press h.  
Subwoofer  
Mode  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Front L  
Front R  
Center  
Mute  
Off  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Select “Mute” to mute the selected speaker channel.  
Select “Off” not to mute the selected speaker channel.  
Sound  
Video  
“Front L” sets whether to mute the audio output from  
the front left speaker.  
“Front R” sets whether to mute the audio output from  
the front right speaker.  
“Center” sets whether to mute the audio output from  
the center speaker.  
“Surround L” sets whether to mute the audio output  
from the surround left speaker.  
Conversion  
Basic  
Component I/P  
NET/USB  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
4
Select the desired parameters and then press  
hto access and adjust.  
“Surround R” sets whether to mute the audio output  
from the surround right speaker.  
PRESET/CH  
“Surround Back L” sets whether to mute the audio  
output from the surround back left speaker.  
“Surround Back R” sets whether to mute the audio  
output from the surround back right speaker.  
“Presence L” sets whether to mute the audio output  
from the presence left speaker.  
“Presence R” sets whether to mute the audio output  
from the presence right speaker.  
“Subwoofer” sets whether to mute the audio output  
from the subwoofer.  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
101 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Component I/P  
Note  
(Component interlace/progressive  
conversion)  
Use the “V-RESET” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set the  
parameters in “Manual Setup (Video)” (except “Short Message”  
and “On Screen”) to the factory presets (see page 136).  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the analog  
interlace/progressive conversion of the analog video  
signals input at the composite video, S-video and  
component video jacks so that the analog video signals  
deinterlaced from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) to 480p/576p  
are output at the COMPONENT MONITOR OUT jacks.  
Choices: Off, On  
Conversion (Video conversion)  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the video  
conversion as well as the HDMI up-conversion of the  
analog video signals input at the composite video, S-video  
and component video jacks.  
Choices: Off, On  
Conversion  
Component I/P  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
HDMI Aspect  
Off  
On  
Off  
Conversion  
On  
Component I/P  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
Select “On” to activate the analog interlace/progressive  
up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Select “Off” to deactivate the analog interlace/  
progressive up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Select “Off” to deactivate the video conversion as well  
as the HDMI up-conversion of the analog video  
signals.  
Select “On” to activate the video conversion as well as  
the HDMI up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Notes  
• This menu item is not available and hence not visible in the GUI  
screen if “Conversion” is set to “Off”.  
If your video monitor does not support analog video signals  
with 480p/576p of resolution, the GUI screen may not be  
displayed on your video monitor when “Component I/P” is set  
to “On”. Use “V-RESET” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set the  
“Component I/P” parameter to the factory preset setting (see  
page 136).  
Notes  
• This unit does not convert 480 line video signals and 576 line  
video signals interchangeably.  
• The analog component video signals with 480i (NTSC)/576i  
(PAL) of resolution are converted to the s-video or composite  
video signals and output at the S VIDEO MONITOR OUT and  
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.  
• The converted video signals are only output at the MONITOR  
OUT jacks. When recording a video source, you must make the  
same type of video connections between each component.  
• When composite video or S-video signals from a VCR are  
converted to component video signals, the picture quality may  
suffer depending on your VCR.  
• Even when “Conversion” is set to “On”, HDMI digital signals  
are not converted to analog video signals.  
• If “Conversion” is set to “Off”, the “Component I/P” and  
“HDMI Up-Scaling” features are deactivated.  
• Set “Conversion” to “On” to display the short message display.  
• Unconventional signals input at the composite video or S-video  
jacks cannot be converted or may be output abnormally. In such  
cases, set “Conversion” to “Off”.  
• When non-standard video signals (such as video signals from a  
game console) are input, this unit may not convert the signals  
even if you “Conversion” to “On”.  
HDMI Up-Scaling (HDMI up-scaling)  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the HDMI up-  
conversion of the analog video signals input at the  
composite video, S-video and component video jacks so  
that the up-scaled analog video signals are output at the  
HDMI OUT jack.  
This unit up-scales the analog video signals as follows:  
• 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) 480p/576p, 1080i or  
720p  
• 480p/576p 1080i or 720p  
Choices: Through, 480p (or 576p), 1080i, 720p  
Conversion  
Component I/P  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
HDMI Aspect  
Through  
480p  
1080i  
720p  
• When the analog component video signals with 480p of  
resolution are input at the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks and the  
video monitor is connected to the VIDEO MONITOR OUT or  
S VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit, the GUI screen is  
not displayed on the video monitor.  
Short Message  
Select “Through” not to up-scale any analog video  
signals.  
Select “480p” (or “576p”), “1080i” or “720p” to up-  
scale analog video signals to 480p or 576p, 1080i or  
720p of resolution.  
102 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Short Message (Short message display)  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the short message  
display function.  
Notes  
• This menu item is not available and hence not visible in the GUI  
menu if “Conversion” is set to “Off” (see page 102).  
Choices: Off, On  
• When you set “TV FORMAT” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to  
“NTSC” (see page 136), “480p” appears in the choices of  
“HDMI Up-Scaling”, and when you set “TV FORMAT” to  
“PAL”, “576p” appears in the choices of “HDMI Up-Scaling”.  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
HDMI Aspect  
Short Message  
On Screen  
Off  
On  
HDMI Aspect (HDMI aspect ratio)  
Use this feature to select the adjustment of aspect ratio for  
HDMI video signal sources.  
Position  
Choices: Through, 16:9 Normal, Smart Zoom  
Select “On” to activate the short message display  
function. The contents of the front panel display appear  
at the bottom of the screen each time you operate this  
unit.  
Select “Off” to deactivate the short message display  
function.  
Component I/P  
HDMI Up-Scaling  
HDMI Aspect  
Short Message  
On Screen  
Through  
16:9 Normal  
Smart Zoom  
Note  
The short message display does not appear in the following cases:  
– when the component video signals with 720p, 1080i or 1080p  
resolutions are input  
Select “Through” if you do not make any adjustments  
to the aspect ratio for HDMI video signal sources.  
Select “16:9 Normal” to display video images with 4:3  
of aspect ratio on your video monitor with 16:9 of  
aspect ratio. Black stripes appear on the right and left  
sides as a result.  
Select “Smart Zoom” to fit video images with 4:3 of  
aspect ratio to your video monitor with 16:9 of aspect  
ratio.  
– When HDMI video signals are input  
On Screen (On-screen display time)  
Use this feature to set the amount of time to display the  
XM Satellite Radio information, iPod or NET/USB menu  
on the video monitor after you perform a certain  
operation.  
Choices: Always, 10sec, 30sec  
Notes  
• When “HDMI Up-Scaling” is set to “Through”, you cannot  
make any adjustments to “HDMI Aspect”.  
HDMI Aspect  
Short Message  
On Screen  
Always  
10sec  
30sec  
• When “HDMI Aspect” is set to “Smart Zoom”, the video  
images of the edge of the video monitor are rather stretched.  
• When the video signals are input at HDMI IN jacks or the  
signals are input with 720p or 1080i of resolution, the setting of  
“HDMI Aspect” does not affect the video signals output at the  
HDMI OUT jack.  
Position  
Wall Paper  
Select “Always” to display the menu screen  
unceasingly during an operation.  
Select “10sec” to turn off the menu screen 10 seconds  
after you perform a certain operation.  
Select “30sec” to turn off the menu screen 30 seconds  
after you perform a certain operation.  
103 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Position (GUI screen position)  
Use this feature to adjust the vertical and horizontal  
position of the GUI screen.  
Manual Setup (Basic)  
Use this menu to manually adjust any speaker setting.  
Control range: –5 (downward/left) to +5 (upward/right)  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
Short Message  
On Screen  
Position  
/
:+5  
/
:-5  
AMP  
+
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
Wall Paper  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Press kto raise the position of the GUI display.  
Press nto lower the position of the GUI display.  
Press hto shift the position of the GUI display to the  
right.  
2
Press k/ non the remote control to select  
“Manual Setup” and then press h.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Press  
l
to shift the position of the GUI display to the left.  
Wall Paper (Wall paper)  
Use this feature to display the wall paper or gray  
background in your video monitor when there is no video  
signal being input.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Choices: None, Yes, Gray  
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control to  
select “Basic” and then press h.  
On Screen  
PRESET/CH  
Position  
None  
Yes  
PRESET/CH  
Wall Paper  
Gray  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Select “None” not to display any background in your  
video monitor.  
Select “Yes” to display a background image (the  
photograph of a piano) in your monitor when there is  
no video signal being input.  
Sound  
Video  
Test Tone  
Basic  
Speaker Set  
Select “Gray” to display a gray background in your  
monitor when there is no video signal being input.  
NET/USB  
Option  
Speaker Distance  
Speaker Level  
Note  
When “Conversion” is set to “Off”, no background is displayed  
even if “Wall Paper” is set to “Yes”.  
4
Select the desired parameters and then press  
hto access and adjust.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
104 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
y
Front (Front speakers)  
• Most of the parameters described in the basic menu are set  
automatically when you run “Auto Setup”. You can use the  
basic menu to make further adjustments, but we recommend  
running “Auto Setup” first.  
Choices: Large, Small  
You can reset these parameters by performing the “Auto Setup”  
procedure (see page 35).  
Front  
Large  
Small  
Test Tone (Test tone)  
Center  
Surround  
Turns the test tone output on or off for “Speaker Set”,  
“Speaker Distance” and “Speaker Level” settings.  
Choices: Off, On  
Select “Large” (large) if you have large front speakers  
that reproduce low-frequency signals effectively. All  
the front left and right channel signals are directed to  
the front left and right speakers.  
Select “Small” (small) if you have small front speakers  
that do not reproduce low-frequency signals  
effectively. The low-frequency signals of the front left  
and right channels are directed to the speakers selected  
in “Bass Out” (see page 107).  
Test Tone  
Off  
On  
Speaker Set  
Speaker Distance  
y
Notes  
If you use a handheld sound pressure level meter, hold at arm’s  
length and point upwards so that the meter is in the listening  
position. With the meter set to the 70 dB scale and to C SLOW,  
calibrate each speaker to 75 dB.  
• When “Bass Out” is set to “Front” (see page 107), the LFE  
signals found in Dolby Digital or DTS sources, the low-  
frequency signals of the front left and right channels, and the  
low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “Small” are all  
directed to the front left and right speakers regardless of the  
“FRONT SP” setting.  
Notes  
• Loud test tones will be output when “On” is selected. In this  
case, make sure no children are present in the listening room.  
• If you select “On” and enter the “Speaker Set”, “Speaker Level”  
or “Speaker Distance” menu, the test tone is output from the  
selected speakers.  
• When “Bass Out” is set to “Front” (see page 107), you can  
select only “Large” in “Front”. If the value of “Front” is set to  
other than “Large” in advance, this unit change the value to  
“Large” automatically.  
Center (Center speaker)  
Choices: Large, Small, None  
Speaker Set (Speaker settings)  
Use to manually adjust any speaker setting.  
Front  
Large  
Small  
None  
Test Tone  
Center  
Speaker Set  
Front  
Surround  
Surround Back  
Speaker Distance  
Speaker Level  
Center  
Surround  
Select “Large” (large) if you have a large center  
speaker that reproduces low-frequency signals  
effectively. All the center channel signals are directed  
to the center speaker.  
Select “Small” (small) if you have a small center  
speaker that does not reproduce low-frequency signals  
effectively. The low-frequency signals of the center  
channel are directed to the speakers selected in “Bass  
Out”.  
y
• If you are not satisfied with the bass sounds from your speakers,  
you can change these settings according to your preference.  
• When the diameter of the woofer section of the speaker unit is  
larger than 16 cm (6.5 in), set the correspondent speaker setting  
parameter to “Large”.  
Select “None” (none) if you did not connect a center  
speaker. The center channel signals are directed to the  
front left and right speakers.  
105 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Surround (Surround left/right speakers)  
Choices: Large, Small, None  
Surround Back (Surround back left/right  
speakers)  
Choices: Large x1, Small x1, Small x2, Large x2, None  
Front  
Center  
Center  
Large  
Small  
None  
Surround  
Large x1  
Small x1  
Small x2  
Large x2  
Surround  
Surround Back  
Presence  
Surround Back  
Presence  
Bass Out  
Select “Large” (large) if you have large surround left  
and right speakers that reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround channel signals are  
directed to the surround left and right speakers.  
Select “Small” (small) if you have small surround left  
and right speakers that do not reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. The low-frequency signals of the  
surround left and right channels are directed to the  
speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”.  
Select “Large x1” (large x 1) if you have a large  
surround back speaker that reproduces low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround back left and right  
channel signals are directed to the surround back left  
speaker.  
Select “Small x1” (small x 1) if you have a small  
surround back speaker that does not reproduce low-  
frequency signals effectively. The low-frequency  
signals of the surround back left and right channels are  
directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”  
and the rest of the signals are directed to the surround  
back left speaker.  
Select “None” (none) if you did not connect surround  
speakers. This unit is set to the Virtual CINEMA DSP  
automatically set to “None”.  
Select “Small x2” (small x 2) if you have two small  
surround back speakers that do not reproduce low-  
frequency signals effectively. The low-frequency  
signals of the surround back left and right channels are  
directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”.  
Select “Large x2” (large x 2) if you have two large  
surround back speakers that reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround back left and right  
channel signals are directed to the surround back left  
and right speakers.  
Select “None” (none) if you did not connect surround  
back speakers. The surround back channel signals are  
directed to the surround left and right speakers.  
Presence (Presence speakers)  
Use this feature if you want to use the presence speakers  
connected to this unit.  
Choices: Yes, None  
Surround  
Surround Back  
Presence  
None  
Yes  
Bass Out  
Bass Cross Over  
Select “NONE” (none) if you did not connect presence  
speakers.  
Select “YES” (yes) if you connected presence speakers  
and want to use them.  
106 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Bass Out (Bass out)  
SWFR Phase (Subwoofer Phase)  
Use this feature to select the speakers that output the LFE  
(low-frequency effect) and the low-frequency signals.  
Choices: Both, SWFR, Front  
Use this feature to switch the phase of your subwoofer if  
bass sounds are lacking or unclear.  
Choices: Normal, Reverse  
Surround Back  
Presence  
Bass Out  
Bass Cross Over  
Bass Out  
Both  
Normal  
SWFR Phase  
Bass Cross Over  
SWFR Phase  
SWFR  
Front  
PR/SB Priority  
Reverse  
Select “Normal” if you do not want to reverse the  
phase of your subwoofer.  
Select “Reverse” to reverse the phase of your  
subwoofer.  
Notes  
Select “Both” (both) if you connected a subwoofer.  
The low-frequency signals of any source are output  
from the subwoofer. The LFE signals as well as the  
low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “Small”  
are directed to the subwoofer. The low-frequency  
signals of the front left and right channels are directed  
to the front left and right speakers and the subwoofer  
regardless of the “Front” setting (see page 107).  
Select “SWFR” (subwoofer) if you connected a  
subwoofer. The LFE signals as well as the low-  
frequency signals of other speakers set to “Small” are  
directed to the subwoofer.  
PR/SB Priority  
(Presence/surround back speaker priority)  
Use this feature to prioritize either the presence or the  
surround back speakers when playing sources that contain  
surround back channel signals using the CINEMA DSP  
sound field programs.  
Choices: Presence, Surround Back  
Select “Front” (front) if you did not connect a  
subwoofer. The LFE signals, the low-frequency signals  
of the front left and right channels, and the low-  
frequency signals of other speakers set to “Small” are  
all directed to the front left and right speakers  
regardless of the “Front” setting (see page 107).  
Bass Cross Over  
Presence  
SWFR Phase  
Surround Back  
PR/SB Priority  
Bass Cross Over (Bass cross over)  
Select “Presence” to use the presence speakers even  
when surround back channel signals are input. The  
signals for the surround back channel will be output  
from the surround speakers.  
Select “Surround Back” to use the surround back  
speakers when surround back channel signals are  
detected in a CINEMA DSP program. The presence  
channel signals are output from the front speakers.  
Use this feature to select the crossover frequency of all the  
speakers set to “Small” or to “None” in “Speaker Set” (see  
pages 105 and 106). All frequencies below the selected  
frequency will be sent to the subwoofer or to the speakers  
set to “Large” in “Speaker Set” (see pages 105 and 106).  
Choices: 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz,  
120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz  
Presence  
40Hz  
60Hz  
80Hz  
90Hz  
100Hz  
Bass Out  
Bass Cross Over  
SWFR Phase  
PR/SB Priority  
107 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Speaker Distance (Speaker distance)  
Use this feature to manually adjust the distance of each  
speaker and the delay applied to the respective channel.  
Ideally, each speaker should be the same distance from the  
main listening position. However, this is not possible in  
most home situations. Thus, a certain amount of delay  
must be applied to the sound from each speaker so that all  
sounds will arrive at the listening position at the same  
time.  
Notes  
You cannot adjust the distance of speakers set to “None” in  
Speaker Set.  
• If you are only using one surround back speaker, connect it to  
the SURROUND BACK (SINGLE) jack, and adjust the  
distance in “Surround Back L”.  
• “Center”, “Surround L”, “Surround R”, “Surround Back L”,  
“Surround Back R”, “Subwoofer”, “Presence L” and “Presence  
R” cannot be adjusted if “Center” (see page 105), “Surround”  
(see page 106), “Surround Back” (see page 106), “Bass Out”  
(see page 107) and “Presence” (see page 106) are set to “None”  
respectively.  
• Instead of “Surround Back L” and “Surround Back R”,  
“Surround Back” is displayed if “Surround Back” is set to either  
“Small x1” or “Large x1” (see page 106).  
Test Tone  
Subwoofer  
Unit  
Speaker Set  
Speaker Distance  
Speaker Level  
Front L  
Front R  
Center  
Unit (Unit)  
Selects the unit for displaying the values of “Speaker  
Distance” parameter.  
Choices: Meter (m), Feet (ft)  
Initial setting:Feet (U.S.A. and Canada models)  
Meter (Other models)  
Speaker distances  
Control range: 0.30 to 24.00 m (1.0 to 80.0 ft)  
Initial setting:  
Front L/Front R/Subwoofer/Presence L/  
Presence R/Subwoofer: 3.00 m (10.0 ft)  
CENTER: 2.60 m (8.5 ft)  
Surround L/Surround R/Surround Back L/  
Surround Back R: 2.40 m (8.0 ft)  
Control step: 0.1 m (0.5 ft)  
Presence R  
Subwoofer  
Meter  
Feet  
Unit  
Front L  
Front R  
Select “Front L” to adjust the distance of the front left  
speaker.  
Select “Front R” to adjust the distance of the front right  
speaker.  
Select “Center” to adjust the distance of the center  
speaker.  
Select “Surround L” to adjust the distance of the  
surround left speaker.  
Select “Surround R” to adjust the distance of the  
surround right speaker.  
Select “Surround Back L” to adjust the distance of the  
surround back left speaker.  
Select “Surround Back R” to adjust the distance of the  
surround back right speaker.  
Select “Presence L” to adjust the distance of the  
presence left speaker.  
Select “Meter” to input speaker distances in meters.  
Select “Feet” to input speaker distances in feet.  
Select “Presence R” to adjust the distance of the  
presence right speaker.  
Select “Subwoofer” to adjust the distance of the  
subwoofer.  
108 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Speaker Level (Speaker level)  
Manual Setup (NET/USB)  
Use this menu to adjust the network and USB system  
parameters.  
Use this feature to manually balance the speaker levels  
between the front left or surround left speakers and each  
speaker selected in “SPEAKER SET” (see page 105).  
Speaker Set  
Presence R  
Subwoofer  
Front L  
Video  
Basic  
Speaker Distance  
Speaker Level  
NET/USB  
Option  
Network  
Front R  
Play Style  
Information  
Center  
Control range: –10.0 dB to +10.0 dB  
Initial setting:  
Network (Network settings)  
Use this feature to view the network parameters (IP  
address, etc.) or to change them manually.  
Front L/Front R/Subwoofer/Presence L/  
Presence R/Subwoofer: 0.0 dB  
CENTER/Surround L/Surround R/Surround Back L/  
Surround Back R: –1.0 dB  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Select “Front L” to adjust the balance of the front left  
speaker.  
Select “Front R” to adjust the balance of the front right  
speaker.  
Select “Center” to adjust the balance of the center  
speaker.  
Select “Surround L” to adjust the balance of the  
surround left speaker.  
Select “Surround R” to adjust the balance of the  
surround right speaker.  
Select “Surround Back L” to adjust the balance of the  
surround back left speaker.  
Select “Surround Back R” to adjust the balance of the  
surround back right speaker.  
Select “Presence L” to adjust the balance of the  
presence left speaker.  
Network  
DHCP  
Play Style  
Information  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Note  
The above display is an example.  
DHCP (DHCP setting)  
When this parameter is set to “ON”, network parameters  
for “IP Address”, “Subnet Mask”, “Default Gateway”,  
“DNS Server (P)” and “DNS Server (S)” obtained from a  
DHCP enabled router are displayed. If DHCP server  
function is not available, set this parameter to “Off” to  
configure the network parameters manually.  
Choices: On, Off  
Select “Presence R” to adjust the balance of the  
presence right speaker.  
Select “Subwoofer” to adjust the balance of the  
subwoofer.  
IP Address (IP address)  
Use this parameter to specify an IP address assigned to  
this unit. This value must not duplicate the one used for  
other devices in the target network.  
Notes  
You cannot adjust the level of channels set to “None” in  
Speaker Set.  
• If you are only using one surround back speaker, connect it to  
the SURROUND BACK (SINGLE) jack, and adjust the balance  
in “Surround Back L”.  
Subnet Mask (Subnet mask)  
Use this parameter to specify the subnet mask value  
assigned to this unit.  
y
For most of the cases, the subnet mask value can be set as  
“255.255.255.0”.  
Default Gateway (Default gateway)  
Use this parameter to specify the IP address of the default  
gateway.  
109 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
DNS Server (P) (Primary DNS server)  
Play Style (Playback styles)  
DNS Server (S) (Secondary DNS server)  
Use this parameter to specify the IP address of the primary  
and secondary DNS (Domain Name System) servers.  
Use this feature to adjust the playback style according to  
your preference. You can shuffle songs in a random order  
or repeat one specific song or a sequence of songs.  
Note  
Network  
If you have only one DNS address, enter the DNS address in  
“DNS Server (P)”. If you have two or more DNS addresses, enter  
one of them in “DNS Server (P)” and another in  
“DNS Server (S)”.  
Play Style  
Repeat  
Shuffle  
Information  
Setup (Setup)  
Select “Setup” to confirm the settings of the “Network”  
parameters.  
Repeat (Repeat)  
Use this feature to set this unit to repeat one song or a  
sequence of songs.  
1
Press k/ non the remote control repeatedly  
and then press hto select and enter the  
desired network parameter.  
Choices: Off, Single, All  
Select “Off” to deactivate this feature.  
Select “Single” to set this unit to repeat one song.  
Select “All” to set this unit to repeat a sequence of  
songs.  
Note  
When “DHCP” is set to “ON”, you cannot select and adjust  
any other network settings. To specify the other parameters,  
you need to first set “DHCP” to “OFF”.  
Notes  
• When “Repeat” is set to a setting other than “Off”, “ ” or  
” appears in the top right corner of the playback status  
2
To specify the parameter, press  
to change the number and press  
the digit to change.  
k
/
n
repeatedly  
to select  
screen while one song or a sequence of songs are being  
repeated.  
• If “Repeat” is set to “Single”, the setting will be reset to “Off”  
when the main zone, Zone 2 and Zone 3 are turned off.  
l
/
h
Shuffle (Shuffle)  
Use this feature to set this unit to play songs or albums in a  
random order.  
Choices: Off, On  
3
4
Press ENTER to confirm the parameter.  
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to configure each  
network parameter.  
Select “Off” to deactivate this feature.  
Select “On” to set this unit to play songs or albums in a  
random order.  
5
Select “Setup” and then press ENTER to  
finish configuration.  
Note  
Note  
When “Shuffle” is set to “On”, “  
” appears in the top right  
corner of the playback status screen while songs or albums are  
being shuffled.  
In case you have changed your network configuration, you may  
need to reconfigure the network settings again.  
y
You can reset the network settings of this unit to the initial factory  
settings by using “N-RESET” in the advanced setup menu (see  
page 136).  
110 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Information (Network information)  
Use this feature to display the network system  
information.  
Manual Setup (Option)  
This menu adjusts the optional system settings.  
Network  
MAC Address  
00:00:00:00:00:00  
Status  
100 BASE-TX  
Full Duplex  
System  
ABCDE123  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
Play Style  
Information  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Note  
2
Press k/ non the remote control to select  
“Manual Setup” and then press h.  
The above display is an example.  
MAC Address  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
(MAC (Media Access Control) address)  
This information displays the MAC address that is  
assigned to this unit.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Status (Network status)  
This information displays the current link status of the  
network.  
Display status: 10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX,  
Full Duplex, Half Duplex, No Link  
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control to  
select “Option” and then press h.  
Note  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
“No Link” appears when network connection is not made.  
System (System ID)  
This information displays the system ID that is assigned to  
this unit.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
Video  
Basic  
Option  
Front Panel Disp.  
iPod  
Zone OSD  
Zone2 Set  
Zone3 Set  
4
Select the desired parameters and then press  
hto access and adjust.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
111 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Front Panel Disp.  
Zone OSD (on-screen display)  
Use this feature to display the operational status of Zone 2  
as well as Zone 3 on the Zone 2 video monitor connected  
to the ZONE VIDEO jacks on the rear panel of this unit.  
The Zone 2 and Zone 3 information to be displayed is  
listed as follows:  
(Front panel display setting)  
Dimmer (Dimmer)  
Use this feature to adjust the brightness of the front panel  
display.  
Control range: – 4 to 0  
The input source of Zone 2 and Zone 3  
The volume level of Zone 2 and Zone 3  
The audio mute status of Zone 2 and Zone 3  
The tonal quality status of Zone 2 and Zone 3  
The XM Satellite Radio information when XM is  
selected as the input source of Zone 2 and Zone 3  
Dimmer  
Scroll  
0
Choices: Off, Zone2, Zone2&Zone3  
Off  
Front Panel Disp.  
iPod  
Scroll (Front panel display message scroll)  
Use this feature to set whether to display the information  
(such as song title or channel name) in the front panel  
display in a continuous manner or by the first 14  
alphanumeric characters after scrolling all characters once  
when “XM”, “DOCK” or “NET/USB” is selected as the  
input source.  
Zone2  
Zone2&Zone3  
Zone OSD  
Zone2 Set  
Zone3 Set  
Select “Off” not to display any operational status of  
Zone 2 and Zone 3 on the Zone 2 video monitor.  
Select “Zone2” to display the operational status of  
Zone 2 only on the Zone 2 video monitor.  
Select “Zone2&Zone3” to display the operational  
status of Zone 2 and Zone 3 on the Zone 2 video  
monitor.  
Choices: Continue, Once  
Dimmer  
Scroll  
Continue  
Once  
Notes  
• If “Zone OSD” is set to “Zone2&Zone3”, changes to the  
operational status of Zone 3 is displayed on the Zone 2 video  
monitor. For example, if the input source of Zone 3 is changed  
while you are watching TV in Zone 2, the name of the changed  
input source of Zone 3 is displayed on your TV in Zone 2.  
• If “Zone OSD” is set to “Zone2&Zone3”, the display contents  
of Zone 2 and Zone 3 depends on whether or not Zone 2 and  
Zone 3 are turned on with ZONE 2 ON/OFF and ZONE 3 ON/  
OFF on the front panel (see page 131).  
– If both Zone 2 and Zone 3 are turned on, the video signals of  
the current input source of Zone 2 and the corresponding OSD  
are displayed on the Zone 2 video monitor.  
– If Zone 2 is turned off and Zone 3 is turned on, only the  
corresponding OSD is displayed in the gray background  
regardless of the REC OUT/ZONE 2 status on the front panel.  
– If Zone 2 is turned on and Zone 3 is turned off, the video  
signals of the current input source of Zone 2 and the  
corresponding OSD are displayed on the Zone 2 video  
monitor.  
Select “Continue” to display the operation status in the  
front panel display in a continuous manner.  
Select “Once” to display the operation status in the  
front panel display by the first 14 alphanumeric  
characters after scrolling all characters once.  
iPod (iPod settings)  
Standby Charge  
(iPod Charge on the standby mode)  
Use this feature to select whether this unit charges the  
battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the  
standby mode (see page 75).  
Choices: Off, Auto  
Off  
– If both Zone 2 and Zone 3 are turned off, no video signals and  
no OSD are displayed on the Zone 2 video monitor.  
Standby Charge  
Auto  
Select “Off” to charge the battery of the stationed iPod  
only when this unit is turned on.  
Select “Auto” to charge the battery of the stationed  
iPod when this unit is turned on and in the standby  
mode.  
112 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Zone2 Volume/Zone3 Volume  
Zone2 Set/Zone3 Set  
(Zone 2/Zone 3 volume)  
(Zone 2/Zone 3 setting)  
Use this feature to select how the volume control will  
operate with regard to the ZONE 2 OUTPUT or ZONE 3  
OUTPUT jacks.  
Zone2 Amplifier/Zone3 Amplifier  
(Zone 2/Zone 3 amplifier)  
Use to select how the Zone 2 and/or Zone 3 speakers are  
amplified.  
Choices: Fixed, Variable  
Choices: EXT, INT:[SP1], INT:[SP2], INT:Both  
Fixed  
Zone2 Amplifier  
Zone2 Volume  
Variable  
Zone2 Max Vol.  
Zone2 Initial Vol.  
EXT  
Zone2 Amplifier  
Zone2 Volume  
Zone2 Max Vol.  
INT:[SP1]  
INT:[SP2]  
Select “Fixed” to fix the ZONE 3 OUTPUT volume  
level to a standard line level.  
Select “Variable” to adjust the ZONE 3 OUTPUT  
volume simultaneously using VOL +/– on the remote  
control.  
Select “EXT” if you want to connect your Zone 2 or  
Zone 3 speakers through an external amplifier  
connected to the ZONE 2 OUTPUT or ZONE 3  
OUTPUT jacks on the rear panel of this unit.  
Select “INT:[SP1]” to use the internal surround back  
amplifier of this unit when you want to connect your  
Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers directly to the SP1 speaker  
terminals on the rear panel of this unit.  
Select “INT:[SP2]” to use the internal surround  
amplifier of this unit when you want to connect your  
Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers directly to the SP2 speaker  
terminals on the rear panel of this unit.  
Select “INT:Both” to use the internal surround and  
surround back amplifiers of this unit when you want to  
connect your Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers directly to  
both the SP1 and the SP2 speaker terminals on the rear  
panel of this unit.  
Zone2 Max Vol./Zone3 Max Vol.  
(Zone 2/Zone 3 Maximum volume)  
Use this feature to set the maximum volume level in the  
Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
Control range: 16.5 dB, 15.0 dB to 30.0 dB  
Control step: 5.0 dB  
Zone2 Amplifier  
Zone2 Volume  
+16.5dB  
Zone2 Max Vol.  
Zone2 Initial Vol.  
Notes  
• When “BI-AMP” is set to “ON” in the “ADVANCED SETUP”  
menu, “INT:[SP1]”, “INT:[SP2]” and “INT:Both” cannot be  
selected.  
• When “INT:Both” is selected for “ZONE2 AMP”, only “EXT”  
can be selected for “ZONE3 AMP”.  
Note  
The “Zone2 Max Vol.” or “Zone3 Max Vol.” setting takes priority  
over the “Zone2 Initial Vol.” or “Zone3 Initial Vol.” setting. For  
example, “Zone2 Initial Vol.” is set to –20.0 dB and then “Zone2  
Max Vol.” is set to –30.0 dB, the volume level is automatically set  
to –30.0 dB when you turn on the power of this unit next time.‘  
• When “INT:Both” is selected for “ZONE3 AMP”, only “EXT”  
can be selected for “ZONE2 AMP”.  
• When you set “ZONE2 AMP” or “ZONE3 AMP” to  
“INT:[SP1]” or “INT:[SP2]” and the corresponding zone is  
turned on, no sound is output from the surround back speakers.  
• When you set “ZONE2 AMP” or “ZONE3 AMP” to  
“INT:Both” and the corresponding zone is turned on, no sound  
is output from both the surround speakers and the surround back  
speakers in the main zone.  
• When both “ZONE2 AMP” and “ZONE3 AMP” are set to  
“INT:[SP1]” or “INT:[SP2]” and Zone 2 and Zone 3 are turned  
on, no sound is output from both the surround speakers and the  
surround back speakers in the main zone.  
• When you use internal amplifiers for Zone 2 or Zone 3, some  
surround field programs may not work in the same way as when  
you do not use the internal amplifiers for Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
113 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Zone2 Initial Vol./Zone3 Initial Vol.  
(Zone 2/Zone 3 Initial volume)  
Use this feature to set the volume level of Zone 2 or Zone  
3 when the power of this unit is turned on.  
Choices: Off, –80 dB to +16.5 dB  
Audio Select  
(Default Audio input jack select)  
Use this feature to designate the default Audio input jack  
select setting when you turn on the power of this unit.  
Choices: Auto, Last  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Zone3 Set  
Zone2 Volume  
Zone2 Max Vol.  
Sur.Initialize  
Audio Select  
Auto  
Last  
Off  
Zone2 Initial Vol.  
Decoder Mode  
Memory Guard  
Select “Auto” if you want this unit to automatically  
detect the type of input signals and select the  
appropriate Audio input jack select setting.  
Select “Last” if you want this unit to automatically  
select the last selected Audio input jack select setting  
used for the connected input source.  
Note  
The “Zone2 Max Vol.” or “Zone3 Max Vol.” setting takes priority  
over the “Zone2 Initial Vol.” or “Zone3 Initial Vol.” setting.  
Sur.Initialize (Surround initialize)  
Use this feature to initialize the parameters for each sound  
field program within sound field program groups. When  
you initialize a sound field program group, all of the  
parameter values within that group revert to their initial  
settings.  
Adjusted sound field parameter settings are displayed in  
blue.  
Choices: CLASSICAL, LIVE/CLUB,  
ENTERTAINMENT, MOVIE, STEREO,  
SUR. DECODE, All  
Decoder Mode (Default decoder mode)  
You can select the decoder used by this unit.  
Choices: Auto, Last  
Sur. Initialize  
Audio Select  
Decoder Mode  
Memory Guard  
HDMI Set  
Auto  
Last  
Select “Auto” if you want this unit to automatically  
detect input signal types and select the appropriate  
decoder.  
Select “Last” if you want this unit to automatically  
select the last decoder used for the connected source.  
CLASSICAL  
LIVE/CLUB  
ENTERTAINMENT  
MOVIE  
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
All  
Zone2 Set  
Zone3 Set  
Sur.Initialize  
Audio Select  
Decoder Mode  
Memory Guard (Memory Guard)  
Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP  
program parameter values and other system settings.  
Choices: Off, On  
Press k/ n/ l/ hto select the sound field program  
you want to initialize and then press ENTER.  
Select “All” to initialize settings for all sound field  
program parameters.  
Audio Select  
Note  
Decoder Mode  
Sound field program groups cannot be initialized when “Memory  
Guard” is set to “On” (see page 114).  
Off  
On  
Memory Guard  
HDMI Set  
Select “On” to protect:  
DSP program parameters  
All menu items except “Memory Guard” and “System  
Memory” – “Load”.  
The start and reload of the “Auto Setup” procedure.  
114 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
y
When you select the protected parameter, “ ” appears at the  
System Memory  
bottom left of the GUI screen.  
Use this feature to save up to six of your favorite settings  
that can be easily recalled when needed. You can save  
settings such as the following:  
HDMI Set (HDMI settings)  
Use this feature to adjust the HDMI support audio.  
Sound field program parameters  
Speaker settings  
Speaker channel settings  
LFE level  
Dynamic range settings  
Parametric equalizer settings  
Decoder Mode  
Memory Guard  
Support Audio  
HDMI Set  
To save settings  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
Support Audio (Support audio)  
Use this feature to select whether to play back HDMI  
audio signals on this unit or on another HDMI component  
connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the rear panel of this  
unit.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Choices: RX-V2700, Other  
2
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control  
repeatedly to select “System Memory” and  
then press h.  
RX-V2700  
Other  
Support Audio  
Select “Save” and then press ENTER.  
The display of the current settings appears in the GUI  
screen.  
Select “RX-V2700” to play back HDMI audio signals  
on this unit. The HDMI audio signals input at the  
HDMI IN jacks of this unit are not output to the HDMI  
component connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the  
rear panel of this unit.  
Sci-Fi  
SpeakerCH 3/4/0.1  
Select “Other” to play back HDMI audio signals on  
another HDMI component connected to the HDMI  
OUT jack.  
Current  
LFE Level 0dB  
D-Range  
PEQ  
MAX  
YPAO Natural  
Memory 1  
Memory 2  
Note  
The HDMI video signals input at the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 or  
HDMI IN 3 jack of this unit are always output at the HDMI OUT  
jack of this unit.  
4
5
Press k/ non the remote control repeatedly  
to select the desired memory number to save  
the current settings of this unit and then  
press h.  
“Save: ENTER” appears in the bottom right corner of  
the window.  
Press ENTER to save the current settings of  
this unit.  
115 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
To load settings  
Signal Info.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
(Input signal information)  
You can display the format, sampling frequency, channel,  
bit rate and flag data of the current input signal.  
You can display the format, sampling frequency, channel,  
bit rate and flag data of the current input signal.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
The top display appears.  
2
3
Press k/ n/ l/ hon the remote control  
repeatedly to select “System Memory” and  
then press h.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Select “Load” and then press ENTER.  
Sci-Fi  
Current  
Sound  
Video  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
SpeakerCH 3/4/0.1  
LFE Level 0dB  
Memory 1  
Memory 2  
Memory 3  
D-Range  
PEQ  
MAX  
Reset  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
System Memory  
4
Press k/ non the remote control repeatedly  
to select the desired memory number to load  
and then press h.  
2
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select “Signal  
Info.”.  
“Load: ENTER” appears in the bottom right corner of  
the window.  
The audio information about the input source appears  
in the GUI screen.  
PRESET/CH  
5
Press ENTER to load settings.  
y
“Memory 1” and “Memory 2” settings can be recalled simply by  
pressing MEMORY 1 or MEMORY 2 on the remote control.  
When you press MEMORY 1, “Load Memory 1? Yes:Press  
Again” appears in the GUI and “Press MEMORY1!” appears in  
the front panel display. Press MEMORY 1 once more to recall the  
settings.  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
1
MEMORY  
2
3
Press l/ hrepeatedly to select “Audio  
Info.” or “Video Info.”.  
9
0
When you press MEMORY 2, “Load Memory 2? Yes:Press  
Again” appears in the GUI and “Press MEMORY2!” appears in  
the front panel display. Press MEMORY 2 once more to recall the  
settings.  
Auto Setup  
Audio Info.  
Format  
Sampling  
Channel  
Bitrate  
Dialogue  
Flag1  
Flag2  
Video  
- - -  
System Memory  
Signal Info.  
Language  
48kHz  
???  
- - -  
- - -  
- - -  
PRESET/CH  
- - -  
1
MEMORY  
2
9
0
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
Video Info.  
Audio  
Auto Setup  
HDMI Signal  
- - -  
HDMI Resolution  
- - - - - -  
Analog Resolution  
System Memory  
Signal Info.  
Language  
- - -  
480i  
480i  
HDMI Error  
- - -  
116 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GRAPHIC USER INTERFACE (GUI) SCREEN  
Audio information  
Language  
Format (Signal format)  
Use this feature to select the language of the menu items  
and messages that appears in the GUI (graphical user  
interface) screen of this unit.  
Signal format. When this unit cannot detect a digital  
signal, it automatically switches to analog input.  
Note  
Choices: English (English),  
(Japanese),  
Français (French), Deutsch (German),  
Español (Spanish), Русский (Russian)  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect any signals.  
Sampling (Sampling frequency)  
The number of samples per second taken from a  
continuous signal to make a discrete signal.  
y
You can also select the GUI language using the “GUI  
LANGUAGE” parameter in “ADVANCED SETUP” in the front  
panel display (see page 136).  
Note  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect the sampling  
frequency.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
The top display appears.  
Channel (Input channel)  
The number of source channels in the input signal  
(front/surround/LFE). For example, a multi-channel  
soundtrack with 3 front channels, 2 surround  
channels and LFE, is displayed as “3/2/0.1”.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
Note  
“---” appears when there is no source channel available.  
Sound  
Video  
Stereo/Surround  
Input Select  
Bitrate (Bit rate)  
The number of bits passing a given point per second.  
Manual Setup  
Auto Setup  
Basic  
NET/USB  
Option  
Note  
System Memory  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect the bit rate.  
Dialogue  
(Dialogue normalization level)  
The dialogue normalization level preset to the current  
input Dolby Digital and DTS signal.  
2
Press non the remote control repeatedly to  
select Language and then press h.  
Flag1/Flag2 (Signal flags)  
System Memory  
Signal Info.  
Flag data encoded in DTS, Dolby Digital, or PCM  
signals that cue this unit to automatically switch  
decoders.  
Language  
English  
Video information  
Français  
HDMI Signal (HDMI signal type)  
Type of the source video signals and the video signals  
output at the HDMI OUT jack of this unit.  
3
4
Press k/ non the remote control repeatedly  
to select the language of your choice.  
HDMI Resolution (HDMI resolution)  
Resolution of the source video signals and the video  
signals output at the HDMI IN jacks of this unit.  
Press ENTER to confirm your selection.  
Analog Resolution (Analog resolution)  
Resolution of the source video signals and the analog  
video signals output at the COMPONENT  
MONITOR OUT jacks of this unit.  
HDMI Error (HDMI Error)  
Error message for HDMI sources or connected  
HDMI devices. See page 144 for details.  
117 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
In addition to controlling this unit, the remote control can also operate other audiovisual components made by YAMAHA  
and other manufacturers. To control your TV or other components, you must set up the appropriate remote control code  
for each input source (see page 120).  
Controlling this unit, a TV, or other components  
Controlling this unit  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP to control this  
Controlling a TV  
Set the operation mode selector to TV to control your TV.  
To control your TV, you must set the appropriate remote  
control code for DTV or PHONO (see page 120). When  
you set the remote control codes for both DTV and  
PHONO, priority is given to the one set for DTV.  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
*1  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
*2  
*1  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
SELECT  
SELECT  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
*1  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
*1  
SRCH MODE  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A/B/C/D/E  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
*1  
*2  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
8
5
6
7
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
9
0
+
*2  
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
(U.S.A. model)  
(U.S.A. model)  
Notes  
Notes  
*1 These buttons always control this unit regardless of the  
operation mode selector position.  
*1 These buttons always control your TV regardless of the  
operation mode selector position.  
*2 These buttons control this unit only when the component  
operation mode selector is set to AMP.  
Remote control  
Digital TV/Cable TV  
TV POWER  
Turns on or off the power.  
Increases or decreases the volume  
level.  
TV VOL +/–  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
Mutes the audio output.  
Changes the input source.  
*2 These buttons control your TV only when the operation mode  
selector is set to TV. For details, see the “TV” column on  
page 119.  
118 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
Controlling other components  
PRESET/CH  
8
9
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
MENU  
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE to control  
other components selected with the input selector buttons.  
You must set the appropriate remote control code for each  
input source in advance (see page 120). The following  
table shows the function of each control button used to  
control other components assigned to each input selector  
button. Be advised that some buttons may not correctly  
operate the selected component.  
3
4
5
SRCH MODE  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
1
2
ENTER  
AUDIO  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
0
A
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
8
5
6
7
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
SELECT  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
y
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
The remote control has 14 modes (input areas) to control  
components so that the remote control can operate up to 14  
different components.  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
SRCH MODE  
(U.S.A. model)  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
MD  
recorder/  
CD  
PC/MCX-  
2000/  
Internet  
Radio/USB  
DVD player/  
DVD  
recorder  
Cable TV/  
Satellite  
tuner  
VCR  
TV  
LD player  
CD player  
Tape deck  
Tuner  
iPod  
recorder  
1
2
AV  
POWER  
VCR power  
*2  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
channel up  
TV  
channel up  
CH +  
Channel up Channel up Channel up  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
channel up  
channel up  
channel up  
channel up  
channel up  
channel up  
TV channel  
down  
TV channel TV channel TV channel TV channel TV channel TV channel TV channel  
Channel  
down  
Channel  
down  
Channel  
down  
CH –  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*3  
down  
down  
down  
down  
down  
down  
down  
*7  
Title  
Title  
Title  
Title  
Band  
Bookmark  
3
4
TITLE  
Subsequent  
menu  
ENTER  
Menu enter  
Menu select Menu select  
Menu up Menu up  
Menu down Menu down  
Menu left Menu left  
Menu right Menu right  
Preset up  
(1 to 8)  
PRESET/CH k Menu up  
PRESET/CH n Menu down  
A-E/CAT. l Menu left  
A-E/CAT. h Menu right  
Up  
Up  
Preset down  
(1 to 8)  
Down  
Down  
Previous  
Preset down  
(A to E)  
Previous  
menu  
*6  
menu  
Subsequent  
Direction  
A/B  
Preset up  
(A to E)  
Subsequent  
menu  
*6  
menu  
5
6
RETURN,  
MEMORY  
Return  
Return  
Return  
Return  
Memory  
Numeric  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
1-9, 0, +10  
*9  
buttons  
VCR search VCR search  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Select NET  
RADIO  
7 ll  
*2  
*2  
*4  
backward  
backward  
VCR search VCR search  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
hh  
Select USB  
*2  
*2  
*4  
forward  
forward  
Chapter/  
Skip  
backward  
Skip  
backward  
Skip  
backward  
Skip  
backward  
Skip  
backward  
Direction  
back  
Skip  
backward  
b
a
*8  
Skip  
forward  
Chapter/  
Skip forward  
Direction  
forward  
Skip forward  
Skip forward Skip forward  
Skip forward  
*8  
Disc skip  
(player)  
Rec (recorder)  
REC/  
DISC  
SKIP  
Select PC/  
MCX  
*2  
*2  
VCR rec  
Rec  
Disc skip  
Stop  
Rec  
Rec  
VCR rec  
*2  
*2  
Stop  
s
Stop  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
Stop  
VCR stop  
VCR stop  
Pause  
(Play/  
Pause)  
VCR pause VCR pause  
e
Pause  
Pause  
Pause  
*2  
*2  
*5  
Play  
(Play/  
Pause)  
*2  
*2  
Play  
p
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
VCR play  
Menu  
VCR play  
Menu  
*5  
Previous  
menu  
Previous  
menu  
8
MENU  
Menu  
Audio  
Audio  
9
0
A
AUDIO  
DISPLAY  
ENT  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Enter  
Enter/recall Enter  
Note  
See page 120 for details about the items marked with asterisk (*).  
119 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Notes  
*1 This button is operational only when the original remote control supplied with the component has a POWER button.  
*2 These buttons operate your VCR only when you set the appropriate remote control code for VCR 1 (see page 120).  
*3 These buttons always control your TV regardless of the operation mode selector position.  
*4 Press and hold to search backward or forward.  
*5 Simple remote mode (see page 75).  
*6 Menu browse mode only (see page 75).  
*7 Press and hold to store your favorite Internet Radio stations with bookmarks (see page 80).  
*8 These buttons are not operational when the Internet Radio is selected as the sub input source of NET/USB.  
*9 Press 1-8 to assign or recall the preset items (see page 81).  
Selecting a component to be controlled  
Setting remote control codes  
You can select a component to be controlled  
independently of the input source selected with the input  
You can control other components by setting the  
selector buttons.  
appropriate remote control codes. Codes can be set up for  
each input area. For a complete list of available remote  
control codes, refer to “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL  
CODES” at the end of this manual.  
Press SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to select the  
desired component.  
The name of the component to be controlled appears in the  
The following table shows the default component  
(Library: component category) and the remote control  
code for each input area.  
display window on the remote control.  
SELECT  
Remote control code default settings  
Library  
(component  
category)  
Default  
code  
Manufacturer  
Input area  
Controlling optional components  
(Option mode)  
XM  
NET/USB  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
TUNER  
TUNER  
TV  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2604  
2607  
“OPTN” is an optional component control area that can be  
programmed with remote control functions independently  
from any input source. This area is useful for  
programming commands that are to be used only as a part  
of a macro function or for components that do not have a  
valid remote control code.  
TUNER  
CD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2602  
2300  
MULTI CH  
INPUT  
DVD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2100  
2606  
To select the option mode, press SELECT n  
repeatedly until “OPTN” appears in the display  
window on the remote control.  
V-AUX/  
DOCK  
TUNER  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
CABLE  
MD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2500  
2400  
SELECT  
CD-R  
TV  
DTV  
VCR 1  
VCR  
DVR  
DVD  
Note  
DVR/VCR2  
DVD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2807  
2100  
You cannot set a remote control code for the optional area. See  
page 122 to program buttons operated within this component  
control area.  
Note  
You may not be able to operate your YAMAHA component even  
if a YAMAHA remote control code is preset as listed above.  
In this case, try setting another YAMAHA remote control code.  
120 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press an input selector button to  
select the input area you want to set up.  
NET/USB  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the  
four-digit remote control code for the  
component you want to use.  
For a complete list of available remote control codes,  
refer to “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at  
the end of this manual.  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
SOURCE  
TV  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
2
3
4
STERE
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECOD
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
8
5
6
7
9
0
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if setting was successful.  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object.  
The library name (ex. L;DVD) and the name of the  
selected input area (ex. DVD) appear alternately in  
the display window on the remote control.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if the setting was unsuccessful. In this case,  
start over from step 3.  
y
If you continuously want to set up another code for another  
component, press the input selector button, or  
SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to select the component, then  
repeat steps 2 through 5.  
LEARN  
6
7
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
y
LEARN  
You can set a remote control code of a different type of  
component to an input area. Press l/ hrepeatedly to  
change the library (component category).  
Library choices: L;DVD, L;DVR, L;LD, L;CD, L;CDR,  
L;MD, L;TAP (tape), L;TUN (tuner),  
L;AMP, L;TV, L;CAB (cable),  
Press por AV POWER to confirm whether  
you can control your component using the  
remote control.  
L;SAT (satellite), L;VCR  
• If you want to setup for another input area, press the input  
selector button, or press SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to  
select the input area.  
POWER  
or  
AV  
Notes  
y
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 2.  
If operation is not possible and the manufacturer of your  
component has more than one code, try each of them until  
you find the correct one.  
Notes  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or  
when you press more than one button simultaneously.  
• The supplied remote control does not contain all possible codes  
for commercially available audio and video components  
(including YAMAHA components). If operation is not possible  
with any of the remote control codes, program the new remote  
control function using the learn feature (see “Programming  
codes from other remote controls”) or use the remote control  
supplied with the component.  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected component  
appears in the display window.  
Note  
0000 appears in the display window if no code has been set.  
• Functions programmed using the learn feature take priority over  
remote control code functions.  
121 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Programming codes from other  
remote controls  
You can program remote control codes from other remote  
controls. Use the learn feature if you want to program  
functions not included in the basic operations covered by  
the remote control codes, or an appropriate remote control  
code is not available. You can program the function of  
other remote control to the buttons in the highlighted areas  
in the following illustration. The buttons can be  
2
Place this remote control about 5 to 10 cm  
(2 to 4 in) apart from the other remote control  
on a flat surface so that their infrared  
transmitters are aimed at each other.  
programmed independently for each input area.  
(U.S.A. model)  
Other remote control  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
SRCH MODE  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
5 to 10 cm (2 to 4 in)  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
A/B/C/D/E  
STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
EFFECT  
MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
3
Press LEARN using a ballpoint pen or similar  
object.  
8
5
6
7
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
SELECT  
“LEARN” and the name of the selected input area  
(ex. “DVD”) appear alternately in the display window  
on the remote control.  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
(U.S.A. model)  
LEARN  
Note  
The remote control transmits infrared rays. If the other remote  
control also uses infrared rays, this remote control can learn most  
of its functions. However, you may not be able to program some  
special signals or extremely long transmissions. Refer to the  
operating instructions for the other remote control.  
Notes  
• Do not press and hold LEARN. If you hold it down for  
more than 3 seconds, the remote enters the remote control  
code setting mode.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press an input selector button to  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the learning mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 3.  
select an input area.  
NET/USB  
4
Press the button for which you want to  
program the new function.  
“LEARN” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
(U.S.A. model)  
(U.S.A. model)  
Note  
Make sure that the operation mode selector is set to SOURCE.  
When you set the operation mode selector to AMP and program a  
remote control codes from other remote controls, the  
programmed key cannot operate the amplifier function of this  
unit.  
122 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Changing source names in the  
5
Press and hold the button you want to  
program on the other remote control until  
“OK” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if learning was unsuccessful. In this case, start  
over from step 4.  
display window  
You can change the name of the input source that appears  
in the display window on the remote control if you want to  
use a different name than the factory preset. This feature is  
useful when you have set an input area to control a  
different component.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press an input selector  
button to select the input area you want to  
rename.  
(U.S.A. model)  
Other remote control  
The name of the selected input area appears in the  
display window.  
AMP  
NET/USB  
SOURCE  
TV  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
y
• If you want to program another function, repeat steps 4  
and 5.  
or  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
AMP  
• If you continuously want to program another function for  
another component, press SELECT k/ nto select the  
component, and then repeat steps 4 and 5.  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
SOURCE  
TV  
(U.S.A. model)  
6
Press LEARN again to exit the learning  
mode.  
LEARN  
Notes  
2
Press RENAME using a ballpoint pen or  
similar object.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or  
when you press more than one button simultaneously.  
• This remote control can learn approximately 200 functions.  
However, depending on the signals learned, “FULL” may  
appear in the display before you program 200 functions. In this  
case, clear unnecessary programmed functions to make room  
for further learning.  
RENAME  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the renaming mode will be automatically canceled.  
In this case, start over from 2.  
• Learning may not be possible in the following cases:  
– when the batteries in the remote control for this unit or other  
components are weak.  
– when the distance between the two remote controls is too  
great or too small.  
– when the remote control infrared windows are not facing each  
other at the appropriate angle.  
– when the remote control is exposed to direct sunlight.  
– when the function to be programmed is continuous or  
uncommon.  
123 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Macro programming features  
3
Press k/ nto select and enter a character.  
Pressing nchanges the character as follows:  
A to Z, 1 to 9, 0, + (plus), – (hyphen), ; (semicolon),  
/ (slash), and space.  
The macro programming feature makes it possible to  
perform a series of operations with the press of a single  
button. For example, when you want to play a CD,  
normally you would turn on the components, select the  
CD input, and press the play button to start playback. The  
macro programming feature lets you perform all of these  
operations simply by pressing the CD macro button. The  
buttons listed as macro buttons below are factory set with  
macro programs. You can also program your own macros  
(see page 126).  
Pressing kchanges the characters in reverse order.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
MACRO operations  
Macro buttons  
4
Press hto move the cursor to the next  
position.  
(U.S.A. model)  
1
MEMORY  
2
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
FREQ/TEXT  
EON  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
NET RADIO  
REC  
USB  
PRESET/CH  
NET/USB AUDIO SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PC/MCX  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
MACRO  
MACRO ON/OFF  
y
1
Set the MACRO ON/OFF selector to ON.  
Press lto move the cursor to the previous position.  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
5
Press ENTER to set the new name.  
“OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if renaming was successful.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if renaming was unsuccessful. In this case,  
start over from step 3.  
2
3
Press the desired macro button.  
y
If you continuously want to rename another input area, press  
the input selector button, or press SELECT k/ nrepeatedly  
to select the component, then repeat steps 3 through 5.  
Set the MACRO ON/OFF selector to OFF  
when you finish to using the macro  
programming operation.  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
6
Press RENAME again to exit the renaming  
mode.  
RENAME  
Notes  
Note  
• While the remote control is running a macro program, it does  
not accept any other operation until it has completed running  
the program (the transmission indicator stops flashing).  
• Continue to aim the remote control at the component the macro  
is operating until the macro operation is complete.  
“ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or when  
you press more than one button simultaneously.  
y
This feature is useful when you change the input or output  
assignment for digital jacks and component video input jacks.  
Refer to “Rename” on page 95.  
124 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Default macro functions  
Pressing  
To automatically transmit these signals in order  
macro button  
First  
Second  
Third  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
POWER  
POWER  
(*1)  
(*2)  
TV  
XM  
NET/USB  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
NET/USB  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
(*3)  
(CD area) (*4)  
MULTI CH IN  
MULTI CH IN  
-
-
V AUX/DOCK  
V AUX/DOCK  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
POWER  
(*1)  
(MD/TAPE area) (*4)  
(CD-R area) (*4)  
DTV  
DTV  
VCR 1  
VCR 1  
(VCR 1 area) (*4)  
(DVR/VCR 2 area) (*4)  
(DVD area) (*4)  
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
*1 You can turn on some components (including YAMAHA components) connected to this unit by connecting them to the AC  
OUTLETS on the rear panel of this unit. Power control may not be synchronized with this unit depending on the component.  
For details, refer to the operating instructions for the connected component.  
*2 When the remote control code for your TV is set up for either DTV or PHONO (see page 120), you can turn on the power of your TV  
without selecting an input source. The remote control code set up for DTV takes priority over the one for PHONO.  
*3 When TUNER is selected as the input source, this unit plays the last station received before the unit was set in the standby mode.  
*4 Playback can be started for any YAMAHA remote control-compatible MD recorder, CD player, CD recorder, DVD player, or DVD  
recorder. When using macros to operate other components, you will need to program the play button on the input area of that  
component (see page 122) or set a remote control code (see page 120).  
125 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Programming macro operations  
You can program your own macro and use the macro  
programming feature to transmit several remote control  
commands in sequence at the press of a button. Be sure to  
set up remote control codes or perform learning operations  
before programming the macro.  
Note  
“AGAIN” appears in the display window if you press a  
button other than a macro button.  
3
Press the buttons for the functions you want  
to include in the macro operation in  
sequence.  
Notes  
You can set up to 10 steps (10 functions). After you  
have set 10 steps, “FULL” appears and the remote  
control automatically exits the macro mode. The  
following example is for programming the following  
procedure:  
Step 1 (“MCR 1”): Press DVD.  
Step 2 (“MCR 2”): Press AV POWER.  
Step 3 (“MCR 3”): Press SLEEP.  
• The default macro is not cleared when a new macro is  
programmed for a button. The default macro can be used again  
when the programmed macro is cleared.  
• It is not possible to add a new signal (macro step) to the default  
macro. Programming a macro changes all macro contents.  
• We do not recommend programming continuous operations  
such as volume control in a macro.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press MACRO using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“MCR ?” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
MCR 2: AV POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
NET/USB SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
MCR 3: SLEEP  
2
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
3
1
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
MCR 1: DVD  
(U.S.A. model)  
MACRO  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Indicates the  
number of macro  
steps entered  
Note  
Flashes alternately so you can  
set the next step  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the macro programming mode will be  
automatically canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
Note  
2
Press the macro button you want to use to  
operate the macro.  
To change the selected input area, press SELECT k/ n.  
Pressing the input selector buttons will program a macro step,  
whereas SELECT k/ nonly changes the selected input area.  
The macro button name (ex. “M;DVD”) and the  
selected component name (ex. “DVD”) appear  
alternately in the display window on the remote  
control.  
4
Press MACRO again using a ballpoint pen or  
similar object when the operation sequence  
you want to program is complete.  
STANDBY  
POWER  
NET/USB  
TUNER  
Note  
PHONO  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
“ERROR” appears in the display window if you press more  
than one button simultaneously.  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
(U.S.A. model)  
126 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing configurations  
You can clear all changes made in each function set, such  
as learned functions, macros, renamed input area names  
and setup remote control ID.  
3
Press and hold CLEAR again for about 3  
seconds.  
WAIT” appears in the display window. If clearing  
was successful, “C;OK” appears in the display  
window on the remote control.  
Clearing function sets  
CLEAR  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press CLEAR by using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“CLEAR” appears in the display window.  
y
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Once you have cleared a learned function for a button, the  
button reverts to the factory setting (or to the manufacturer  
setting, if you have set remote control codes).  
CLEAR  
Notes  
or  
• “L;ALL” and “FCTRY” may take about 30 seconds to  
complete.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window if clearing was  
unsuccessful. In this case start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window if you press a  
button not indicated in the respective step, or if you press  
more than one button simultaneously.  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the clearing mode will be automatically canceled.  
In this case, start over from step 1.  
2
Press k/ nto select the clear mode.  
L;CD (etc.) (L; Name of an input area)  
Clears all learned functions in the respective  
input area. The name of a component is shown  
after a semicolon (;). Press an input selector  
button to select the input area.  
L;AMP  
Clears all learned functions for controlling the  
amplifier functions of this unit.  
Clears all learned functions.  
L;ALL  
M;ALL  
Clears all programmed macros.  
RNAME Clears all renamed source names.  
FCTRY  
Clears all remote functions and returns the  
remote to the factory settings.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
127 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing a learned function  
You can clear the function learned for a certain button in  
each control area.  
3
Press and hold CLEAR using a ballpoint pen  
or similar object and then press the button  
you want to clear for about 3 seconds.  
“C;OK” appears in the display window if clearing  
was successful. Once “C;OK” appears in the display  
window on the remote control, release the ballpoint  
pen or similar object used to press CLEAR to exit the  
clearing mode. The remote control returns to the  
learning mode.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press an input selector  
button to select the input area containing the  
function you want to clear.  
The selected component name appears in the display  
window.  
AMP  
NET/USB  
SOURCE  
MODE PTY SEEK START  
TV  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
or  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
LEARN CLEAR  
AME  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
(U.S.A. model)  
y
(U.S.A. model)  
• If you continuously want to clear another function, repeat  
step 4.  
• If you continuously want to clear another function for  
another component, press SELECT k/ nto select the  
input area, then repeat step 4.  
• Once you clear a learned function, the button reverts to the  
factory setting (or to the manufacturer setting if you have  
set remote control codes).  
2
Press LEARN using a ballpoint pen or similar  
object.  
“LEARN” and the selected component name  
(ex. “DVD”) appear alternately in the display  
window.  
4
Press LEARN again to exit.  
Notes  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
clearing was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window if you press more than  
one button simultaneously.  
LEARN  
Notes  
• Do not press and hold LEARN. If you hold it down for  
more than 3 seconds, the remote control enters the remote  
control code setting mode.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the learning mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 2.  
128 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing a macro function  
You can clear the function programmed for a certain  
macro button.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press MACRO using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“MCR ?” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
MACRO  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the macro programming mode will be  
automatically canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
2
Press and hold CLEAR using a ballpoint pen  
or similar object, then press the macro  
button you want to clear for about 3 seconds.  
“C;OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if clearing was successful.  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
DVD  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
ME  
(U.S.A. model)  
y
• If you continuously want to clear another function, repeat  
step 2.  
• Once you clear a programmed function, the button reverts  
to the factory setting (or to the manufacturer setting if you  
have set remote control codes).  
3
Press MACRO again to exit the macro  
programming mode.  
Notes  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
clearing was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press more than one button simultaneously.  
129 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
This unit allows you to configure a multi-room audio/video system. The multi-zone configuration feature enables you to  
set this unit to reproduce separate input sources in the main room, second room (Zone 2) and third room (Zone 3). You  
can control this unit from the second or third room using the supplied remote control.  
Only analog signals are sent to the second and third rooms. Any source you want to listen to in the second or third  
room must be connected using the analog (AUDIO L/R) input jacks on this unit.  
Connecting the Zone 2 and Zone 3 components  
You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-room functions of this unit:  
An infrared signal receiver in the second and/or third room.  
An infrared emitter in the main room. This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second  
and/or third room to the main room (to a CD player or DVD player, for example).  
An amplifier and speakers for the second and/or third room.  
A video monitor for the second room  
y
You do not need an extra amplifier and speakers for the second and/or third room if you want to use the internal amplifiers of this unit.  
• Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-room configuration, we recommend that you consult with  
your nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for the Zone 2 and Zone 3 connections that best meet your requirements.  
REMOTE  
IN  
REMOTE  
IN  
REMOTE  
IN  
OUT  
REMOTE  
OUT  
OUT  
Infrared signal  
receiver  
YAMAHA  
component  
YAMAHA  
component  
This unit  
Using external amplifiers  
To use an external amplifier in Zone 2 or Zone 3, connect the external amplifier to ZONE OUT terminals and select  
“EXT” in “Zone2 Amplifier” or “Zone3 Amplifier” (see page 113).  
ZONE 3 AUDIO OUT  
ZONE 2 VIDEO OUT  
ZONE 2 AUDIO OUT  
SP OUT  
Amplifier  
Amplifier  
MONITOR OUT  
DVD player  
(or other component)  
This unit  
SYSTEM  
Remote control  
Remote control  
MAIN  
ZONE 3  
ZONE 2  
VIDEO IN  
AUDIO IN  
Infrared signal  
receiver  
Infrared signal  
receiver  
Infrared emitter  
Main room  
(Main zone)  
Second room  
(Zone 2)  
Third room  
(Zone 3)  
REMOTE OUT  
REMOTE IN  
REMOTE IN  
Notes  
• Adjust the Zone 2/Zone 3 volume by using the amplifier in the second/third room when “Zone2 Volume” or “Zone3 Volume” are set to  
“Fixed” (see page 113).  
• To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT use the Zone 2/Zone 3 feature with CDs encoded in DTS.  
130 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Using the internal amplifiers of this unit  
IMPORTANT SAFETY NOTICE  
The SP1 or SP2 speaker terminals of this Receiver should not be connected to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or  
more than one loudspeaker per channel.  
Connection to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or multiple speakers per channel could create an abnormally low  
impedance load resulting in amplifier damage. See this owner’s manual for correct usage.  
Compliance with minimum speaker impedance information for all channels must be maintained at all times. This  
information is found on the back panel of your Receiver.  
If you want to use one internal amplifier (SP1 or SP2) of this unit  
Connect the Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers directly to the SP1 or SP2 speaker terminals and select either “INT:[SP1]” or  
“INT:[SP2]” for “Zone2 Amplifier” or “Zone3 Amplifier” (see page 113).  
If you want to use two internal amplifiers (both SP1 and SP2) of this unit  
Connect the Zone 2 or Zone 3 speakers directly to the SP1 and SP2 speaker terminals and select “Both” for “Zone2  
Amplifier” or “Zone3 Amplifier” (see page 113).  
SP1  
+
+
PRESENCE  
+
+
R
R
L
L
R
SP2  
L
+
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
SINGLE  
Second room  
(Zone 2)  
Third room  
(Zone 3)  
This unit  
Controlling Zone 2 or Zone 3  
You can select the zone you want to control by using the  
2
Press ZONE CONTROLS on the front panel  
repeatedly to select the zone you want to  
control.  
control buttons on the front panel or on the remote control.  
ZONE CONTROLS  
Selecting Zone 2 or Zone 3  
Each time you press ZONE CONTROLS, the front  
panel display changes as shown below, and the  
indicator for the currently selected zone flashes for  
approximately 5 seconds. However, no indicator  
flashes when the main zone is selected.  
Front panel operations  
1
Press ZONE 2 ON/OFF or ZONE 3 ON/OFF on  
the front panel to individually turn on or off  
Zone 2 or Zone 3.  
ZONE2  
ZONE3  
ZONE ON/OFF  
No indicator flashes when the main zone is  
selected.  
ZONE 2  
ZONE 3  
ZONE2  
y
Controls the Zone 2 amplifier or tuner functions.  
Once MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel is pressed  
inward to the ON position, you can also press POWER and  
STANDBY on the remote control to turn on the main zone,  
Zone 2 and Zone 3.  
ZONE3  
Controls the Zone 3 amplifier or tuner functions.  
131 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
y
Turning on or off Zone 2 and/or Zone 3  
using the remote control  
POWER and STANDBY on the remote control work  
differently depending on the selected zone that appears in  
the display window on the remote control.  
You must complete this step within 5 seconds while the  
selected zone flashes in the front panel display. Otherwise,  
the currently selected zone mode is automatically  
canceled. In this case, press ZONE CONTROLS again.  
• The initial setting is ZONE2 when both Zone 2 and Zone 3  
are turned on.  
When the main zone, Zone 2 or Zone 3 mode is  
selected (see page 132), you can turn on the main zone,  
Zone 2 or Zone 3 or set them to the standby mode  
individually.  
3
operations.  
When the all mode is selected, pressing POWER turns  
on the main zone, Zone 2 and Zone 3 simultaneously  
and pressing STANDBY sets them to the standby mode  
simultaneously.  
POWER  
Control mode  
Display window  
and  
STANDBY  
Remote control operations  
Turns on the main  
zone only or sets it to  
the standby mode.  
Main zone  
mode  
Name of the selected  
input area  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SELECT krepeatedly to select the  
zone you want to control.  
“ZONE 2” or “2;name Turns on Zone 2 or  
Zone 2 mode of the selected input  
sets it to the standby  
mode.  
area”  
“ZONE 2” or “ZONE 3” is displayed in the display  
window on the remote control.  
“ZONE 3” or “3;name Turns on Zone 3 or  
Zone 3 mode of the selected input  
sets it to the standby  
mode.  
area”  
AMP  
POWER: turns on  
the main zone, Zone  
2 and Zone 3.  
STANDBY: sets the  
main zone, Zone 2  
and Zone 3 to the  
standby mode.  
SOURCE  
SELECT  
TV  
All mode  
“ALL”  
Notes  
or  
• When the remote control is in the main zone mode, “MAIN”  
appears for a few seconds when POWER or STANDBY is  
pressed.  
• “ALL” appears in the display window on the remote control  
only when SELECT nis pressed.  
2
3
operations.  
Selecting the input source of Zone 2 or  
Zone 3  
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel (or  
set the operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press one of the input selector buttons on the  
remote control) to select the input source of the  
selected zone.  
If the remote control is used to select the input source, “2:  
name of the selected input area” or “3: name of the  
selected input area” is displayed in the display window on  
the remote control when Zone 2 or Zone 3 is selected  
respectively.  
Press SELECT k/ nto exit from the  
Zone 2/Zone 3 mode.  
132 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Note  
INPUT  
When you use the external amplifiers in Zone 2 or Zone 3,  
VOLUME +/– can be used only when “Zone2 Volume” or  
“Zone3 Volume” is set to “Variable” in “Zone2 Set” or “Zone3  
Set” (see page 113).  
Adjusting the balance of the speaker  
or  
level in Zone 2 or Zone 3  
NET/USB  
TUNER  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Press TONE CONTROL repeatedly to select  
“BALANCE” and then rotate PROGRAM on the  
front panel to adjust the balance of the front left  
and right speaker level of the selected zone.  
PHONO  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
(U.S.A. model)  
TONE  
CONTROL  
Select TUNER as the input source to use the TUNER  
features in the selected zone. For details about the  
TUNER operations, see “FM/AM TUNING” on  
Select XM as the input source to use the XM Satellite  
Radio features in the selected zone. For details about  
the XM Satellite Radio operations, see “XM  
PROGRAM  
Adjusting the tonal quality of Zone 2 or  
Zone 3  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press CH +/– on the remote control to adjust the  
high-frequency response (TREBLE) or  
TV VOL +/– to adjust the low-frequency response  
(BASS) respectively.  
Note  
The selected input source is shared across all zones.  
y
You must complete this step within 5 seconds while the selected  
zone flashes in the front panel display. Otherwise, the currently  
selected zone mode is automatically canceled. In this case, press  
ZONE CONTROLS on the front panel again.  
+
TV VOL  
• When a video monitor is connected to one of the ZONE VIDEO  
jacks, you can display the control information of Zone 2 or  
Zone 3 and XM Satellite Radio information on the video  
monitor screen. Set “Zone OSD” to “Zone2&Zone3” or  
“Zone2” (see page 112).  
AMP  
BASS  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
CH  
Adjusting the volume level of Zone 2 or  
Zone 3  
Rotate VOLUME on the front panel (or press  
VOLUME +/– on the remote control) to adjust the  
volume level of the selected zone.  
TREBLE  
y
VOLUME  
You can also adjust the tonal quality of Zone 2 or Zone 3 by using  
TONE CONTROL on the front panel. For details, see “Adjusting  
+
VOLUME  
or  
Note  
Check that “ZONE 2” or “ZONE 3” is displayed in the display  
window of the remote control before you adjust the tonal quality  
of the corresponding zone (see page 132).  
y
Press MUTE on the remote control to mute the sound output to  
the selected zone.  
133 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ADVANCED SETUP  
ADVANCED SETUP  
This unit has additional menus that are displayed in the front panel display. The advanced setup menu offers additional  
operations to adjust and customize the way this unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each  
parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening environment.  
Notes  
• The settings you make are reflected next time you press MASTER ON/OFF inward to the ON position to turn on this unit (see  
• Only MASTER ON/OFF, STRAIGHT and the PROGRAM selector are effective while you are using the advanced setup menu.  
• All the other operations cannot be made while you are using the advanced setup menu.  
• The advanced setup menu is only available in the front panel display.  
Using ADVANCED SETUP  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select the parameter you want to  
adjust.  
The name of the selected parameter appears in the  
front panel display.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
See page 135 for a complete list of available  
parameters.  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
PROGRAM  
3
2,4  
1-2,5  
Currently selected  
parameter  
Currently selected  
parameter setting  
1
2
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to turn  
off this unit.  
SPEAKER IMP.  
MIN  
8
MASTER  
4
5
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to change the selected parameter  
setting.  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
While holding  
down  
STRAIGHT  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to save  
the new setting and turn off this unit.  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
MASTER  
y
The settings you made are reflected next time you turn on  
this unit.  
134 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
Speaker impedance SPEAKER IMP.  
Use this feature to set the speaker impedance of this unit  
so that it matches that of your speakers.  
Choices: 8MIN, 6MIN  
Wake on RS-232C access  
WAKE ON RS232C  
Use this feature to set this unit to transmit data via the RS-  
232C interface when this unit is in the standby mode.  
Choices: YES, NO  
Select “8ΩMIN” to set the speaker impedance to 8 .  
Select “6MIN” to set the speaker impedance to 6 .  
Initial setting:  
[U.S.A. and Canada models]: YES  
[Other models]: NO  
SPEAKER  
Speaker  
Impedance level  
Select “YES” to set this unit to transmit data via the  
RS-232C interface.  
IMP.  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 8 or  
higher.  
Select “NO” to set this unit not to transmit data via the  
RS-232C interface.  
Front  
Remote control AMP ID  
RC AMP ID  
Center  
Surround  
8ΩMIN  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 8 or  
higher.  
Use this feature to set the AMP ID of this unit for remote  
control recognition (see page 121).  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
Surround back  
Select “ID1” when the remote control AMP ID library  
code is set to “2001”.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control AMP ID library  
code is set to “2002”.  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 4 or  
higher.  
Front  
Center  
Surround  
6ΩMIN  
Note  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 6 or  
higher.  
You need to set the corresponding remote control AMP library  
code for the remote control (see page 121).  
Surround back  
Remote control TUNER ID  
RC TUNER ID  
Use this feature to set the TUNER ID of this unit for  
remote control recognition (see page 138).  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
User presets USER PRESET  
Use this feature to reset all the parameters of this unit to  
the initial factory settings (see page 149).  
Choices: CANCEL, RESET  
Select “CANCEL” not to reset any parameters of this  
Select “ID1” when the remote control TUNER ID  
unit.  
library code is set to “2602”.  
Select “RESET” to reset the parameters of this unit.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control TUNER ID  
library code is set to “2603”.  
Notes  
Note  
• This setting completely resets all the parameters of this unit.  
However, the advanced setup menu parameters will not be  
initialized.  
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on  
this unit.  
You need to set the corresponding remote control TUNER library  
code for the remote control (see page 138).  
Remote control XM ID RC XM ID  
(U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
Use this feature to set the XM ID of this unit for remote  
control recognition (see page 138).  
Remote sensor REMOTE SENSOR  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor on the  
front panel of this unit.  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
Select “ID1” when the remote control XM ID library  
Choices: ON, OFF  
code is set to “2604”.  
Select “ON” if you want to activate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor.  
Select “OFF” if you want to deactivate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control XM ID library  
code is set to “2605”.  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control XM library  
code for the remote control (see page 138).  
Note  
We recommend setting the parameter to “ON” in most cases.  
135 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ADVANCED SETUP  
Tuner frequency step TUNER FRQ STEP  
(Asia and General models only)  
Use this feature to set the tuner frequency step according  
to the frequency spacing in your area.  
TV format TV FORMAT  
Use this feature to set the color encoding format of your  
television.  
Choices: NTSC, PAL  
Initial setting:  
Choices: AM10/FM100, AM9/FM50  
[U.S.A., Canada, General and Korea models]: NTSC  
[Other models]: PAL  
Select “AM10/FM100” for North, Central and South  
America.  
Select “AM9/FM50” for all other areas.  
Note  
Bi-AMP BI-AMP  
Use to activate or deactivate the bi-AMP function.  
Choices: ON, OFF  
This parameter setting only affects the video monitor connected  
to the MONITOR OUT jacks and does not affect the Zone 2  
video monitor connected to the ZONE 2 VIDEO jacks.  
Select “ON” if you want to activate the bi-AMP  
function.  
Select “OFF” if you want to deactivate the bi-AMP  
function.  
Monitor check for HDMI up-scaling  
MONITOR CHECK  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the monitor check  
function of this unit. When this parameter is set to “YES”,  
this unit receives the information of the available video  
signal resolutions from the video monitor connected via  
HDMI (see page 102).  
Note  
When “BI-AMP” is set to “ON”, the SURROUND BACK  
terminals cannot be used to connect surround back speakers in  
that the SURROUND BACK terminals are already used for the  
bi-AMP connection (see page 19).  
Choices: YES, SKIP  
GUI language GUI LANGUAGE  
Use this feature to select the language of your choice that  
appears in the GUI (graphical user interface) menu of this  
unit.  
Choices: ENGLISH (English), JAPANESE (Japanese),  
FRENCH (French), GERMAN (German), SPANISH  
(Spanish), RUSSIAN (Russian)  
Video reset VIDEO RESET  
Use to initialize the parameter settings for “Video” in  
Choices: YES, CANCEL  
Note  
The parameter setting for “Short Message” or “On Screen” is not  
initialized (see page 101).  
Network reset NETWORK RESET  
Use this feature to reset the network settings of this unit  
(see page 109) to the initial factory settings.  
Choices: CANCEL, RESET  
Select “CANCEL” not to reset any network settings of  
this unit.  
Select “RESET” to reset the network settings of this  
unit.  
Notes  
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on  
this unit.  
• When the network settings are reset, “DHCP” in “NET/USB” is  
automatically set to “On” (see page 109) and the registered  
client ID of this unit on your YAMAHA MCX-2000 is cleared  
136 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ADVANCED SETUP  
Setting remote control ID  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the  
four-digit remote control code for the input  
area you want to use.  
When using multiple YAMAHA receivers/amplifiers, you  
may be able to operate the other components  
simultaneously with the default code setting. In this case,  
set one of the alternative codes to operate this unit  
separately.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STERE
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECOD
8
5
6
7
Setting remote control AMP ID  
9
0
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE.  
Remote control AMP codes  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
AMP code for the input area you want to use.  
or  
AMP library  
Remote  
code  
(remote control  
Function  
control AMP  
ID  
setting)  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object and  
then press l/ hrepeatedly until “L;AMP”  
appears in the display window on the remote  
2001  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting)  
(initial setting) default code.  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
2002  
ID2  
control.  
PRESET/CH  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control AMP ID  
(see page 135).  
LEARN  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window if setting was  
successful.  
“NG” appears in the display window if the setting  
was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 1.  
PRESET/CH  
Notes  
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
6
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected input area  
appears in the display window on the remote control.  
LEARN  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
137 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ADVANCED SETUP  
Setting remote control tuner ID or XM ID  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the  
four-digit remote control code for the input  
area you want to use.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press TUNER or XM on  
the remote control to select the tuner or XM  
to change the remote control ID.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
AMP  
8
5
6
7
TUNER  
SOURCE  
9
0
TV  
or  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Remote control tuner codes  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
tuner code for the input area you want to use.  
XM  
Tuner library  
Remote  
code  
(remote control  
Function  
control  
tuner ID  
setting)  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object and  
then press l/ hrepeatedly until “L;TUN”  
and “TUNER”, or “L;TUN” and “XM”  
2602  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting)  
(initial setting) default code.  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
2603  
ID2  
alternately appear in the display window on  
Remote control XM codes  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
XM code for the input area you want to use.  
the remote control.  
PRESET/CH  
LEARN  
XM library  
Remote  
ENTER  
code  
A/B/C/D/E  
Function  
control XM  
ID  
(remote control  
setting)  
2604  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting) default code.  
(initial setting)  
Notes  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
2605  
ID2  
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control tuner ID  
or XM ID (see page 135).  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected input area  
appears in the display window on the remote control.  
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window if setting was  
successful.  
PRESET/CH  
“NG” appears in the display window if the setting  
was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 1.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
ENTER  
A/B/C/D/E  
6
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
LEARN  
138 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below  
or if the instruction below does not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized  
YAMAHA dealer or service center.  
General  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit fails to turn  
on or enters the  
standby mode soon  
after the power is  
turned on.  
The power cable is not connected or the  
plug is not completely inserted.  
Connect the power cable firmly.  
The speaker impedance setting is  
incorrect.  
Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers.  
The protection circuitry has been  
activated.  
Make sure that all speaker wire connections on this  
unit and on all speakers are secure and that the wire  
for each connection does not touch anything other  
than its respective connection.  
This unit has been exposed to a strong  
external electric shock (such as lightning  
or strong static electricity).  
Set this unit to the standby mode, disconnect the  
power cable, plug it back in after 30 seconds and then  
use it normally.  
No sound.  
Incorrect input or output cable  
connections.  
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,  
the cables may be defective.  
The optimizer microphone is connected.  
Disconnect the optimizer microphone.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.  
Audio input jack select is set to “HDMI”,  
“COAX/OPT” or “ANALOG”.  
Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG” while playing a source  
encoded in Dolby Digital or DTS.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO” or  
“COAX/OPT”.  
No appropriate input source has been  
selected.  
Select an appropriate input source with the INPUT  
selector on the front panel (or the input selector  
buttons on the remote control).  
Speaker connections are not secure.  
The volume is turned down.  
The sound is muted.  
Secure the connections.  
Turn up the volume.  
Press MUTE or VOLUME +/– on the remote control  
to resume audio output and then adjust the volume.  
Signals this unit cannot reproduce are  
being input from a source component,  
such as a CD-ROM.  
Play a source whose signals can be reproduced by this  
unit.  
The HDMI components connected to this  
unit do not support the HDCP copy  
protection standards.  
Connect HDMI components that support the HDCP  
copy protection standards.  
“Support Audio” is set to “Other” and  
“HDMI” audio signals are not being  
played back on this unit.  
Set “Support Audio” to “RX-V2700” in “Option”.  
139 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
No picture.  
The output and input for the picture are  
connected to different types of video  
jacks.  
Set “Conversion” to “On” or connect your source  
components in the same way as you connect your  
video monitor to this unit.  
Non-standard video signals are input.  
“Short Message” is set to “OFF”.  
“Wall Paper” is set to “None”.  
“Conversion” is set to “Off”.  
Short message  
displays do not  
appear in the video  
monitor.  
Set “Short Message” to “On”.  
Set “Wall Paper” to “Yes” or “Gray”.  
Set “Conversion” to “On”.  
The signals input at the HDMI IN1,  
HDMI IN2 or HDMI IN3 jack are being  
output at the HDMI OUT jack.  
Video signals in the progressive format or  
HDTV video signals are being input.  
The sound suddenly  
goes off.  
The protection circuitry has been activated Check that the speaker impedance setting is correct.  
because of a short circuit, etc.  
Check that the speaker wires are not touching each  
other and then turn this unit back on.  
The sleep timer has turned off this unit.  
The sound is muted.  
Turn on this unit, and play the source again.  
Press MUTE or VOLUME +/– on the remote control  
to resume audio output.  
Sound is heard from  
the speaker on one  
side only.  
Incorrect cable connections.  
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,  
the cables may be defective.  
Incorrect settings in “Speaker Level”.  
Adjust the “Speaker Level” settings.  
Only the center  
speaker outputs  
substantial sound.  
When playing a monaural source with a  
CINEMA DSP program, the source signal  
is directed to the center channel, and the  
front and surround speakers output effect  
sounds.  
No sound is heard  
from the center  
speaker.  
“Center” in “Speaker Set” is set to  
“None”.  
Set “Center” to “Small” or “Large”.  
One of the HiFi DSP programs (except for Try another sound field program.  
“7ch Stereo”) has been selected.  
No sound is heard  
from the presence  
speakers.  
The sound field programs are turned off.  
Press STRAIGHT to turn them on.  
Try another sound field program.  
You are using a source or program  
combination that does not output sound  
from all channels.  
No sound is heard  
from the surround  
speakers.  
“Surround” in “Speaker Set” is set to  
“None”.  
Set “Surround” to “Small” or “Large”.  
This unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode  
and a monaural source is being played  
back.  
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel so that  
“STRAIGHT” disappears from the front panel  
display.  
No sound is heard  
from the subwoofer.  
“Bass Out” in “Speaker Set” is set to  
“Front” when a Dolby Digital or DTS  
signal is being played.  
Set “Bass Out” to “SWFR” or “Both”.  
“Bass Out” in “Speaker Set” is set to  
“SWFR” or “Front” when a 2-channel  
source is being played.  
Set “Bass Out” to “Both”.  
The source does not contain low-  
frequency signals.  
140 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
No sound is heard  
from the surround  
back speakers.  
“Surround” in “Speaker Set” is set to  
“None” and “Surround Back” is  
automatically set to “None”.  
Set “Surround” and “Surround Back” to a setting  
other than “None”.  
“Surround Back” in “Speaker Set” is set to Set “Surround Back” to a setting other than “None”.  
“None”.  
Dolby Digital or DTS  
sources cannot be  
played. (Dolby Digital  
or DTS indicator in  
the front panel  
The connected component is not set to  
output Dolby Digital or DTS digital  
signals.  
Make an appropriate setting following the operating  
instructions for your component.  
Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG”.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.  
display does not light  
up.)  
A humming sound is  
heard.  
Incorrect cable connections.  
Connect the audio cables firmly. If the problem  
persists, the cables may be defective.  
No connection from the turntable to the  
GND terminal.  
Connect the grounding cable of your turntable to the  
GND terminal of this unit.  
The volume level is  
low while a record is  
being played.  
The record is being played on a turntable  
with an MC cartridge.  
Connect your turntable to this unit through an MC-  
head amplifier.  
The volume level  
cannot be increased,  
or the sound is  
distorted.  
The component connected to the AUDIO  
OUT (REC) jacks of this unit is turned  
off.  
Turn on the power of the component.  
The sound effect  
cannot be recorded.  
It is not possible to record the sound effect  
with a recording component.  
A source cannot be  
recorded by a digital  
recording component  
connected to the  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
jack.  
The source component is not connected to Connect the source component to the DIGITAL  
the DIGITAL INPUT jacks of this unit.  
INPUT jacks.  
Some components cannot record Dolby  
Digital or DTS sources.  
A source cannot be  
recorded by an  
analog component  
connected to the  
AUDIO OUT (REC)  
jacks.  
The source component is not connected to Connect the source component to the analog AUDIO  
the analog AUDIO IN jacks of this unit.  
IN jacks.  
The sound field  
“Memory Guard” in “Option” is set to  
Set “Memory Guard” to “Off”.  
parameters and some “On”.  
other settings of this  
unit cannot be  
changed.  
141 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit does not  
operate properly.  
The internal microcomputer has been  
frozen by an external electric shock (such  
as lightning or excessive static electricity)  
or by a power supply with low voltage.  
Disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet  
and then plug it in again after about 30 seconds.  
“CHECK SP WIRES”  
appears in the front  
panel display.  
Speaker cables are short-circuited.  
Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly.  
There is noise  
interference from  
digital or radio  
This unit is too close to the digital or high- Move this unit further away from such equipment.  
frequency equipment.  
frequency equipment.  
The picture is  
disturbed.  
The video source uses scrambled or  
encoded signals to prevent dubbing.  
This unit suddenly  
enters the standby  
mode.  
The internal temperature becomes too  
high and the overheat protection circuitry  
has been activated.  
Wait about 1 hour for this unit to cool down and then  
turn it back on.  
Tuner  
Problem  
noisy.  
See  
page  
Cause  
Remedy  
FM stereo reception is  
The characteristics of FM stereo  
broadcasts may cause this problem  
when the transmitter is too far away or  
the antenna input is poor.  
Check the antenna connections.  
Try using a high-quality directional FM  
antenna.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
There is distortion, and  
There is multi-path interference.  
The signal is too weak.  
Adjust the antenna position to eliminate  
multi-path interference.  
clear reception cannot  
be obtained even with a  
good FM antenna.  
FM  
The desired station  
cannot be tuned into  
with the automatic  
tuning method.  
Use a high-quality directional FM antenna.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
Previously preset  
stations can no longer  
be tuned into.  
This unit has been disconnected for a  
long period.  
Preset the stations again.  
The desired station  
cannot be tuned into  
with the automatic  
tuning method.  
The signal is weak or the antenna  
connections are loose.  
Tighten the AM loop antenna connections  
and orient it for the best reception.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
AM  
There are continuous  
crackling and hissing  
noises.  
Noises can result from lightning,  
fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats  
and other electrical equipment.  
Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire.  
This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to  
eliminate all noise.  
There are buzzing and  
whining noises.  
A TV set is being used nearby.  
Move this unit away from the TV set.  
142 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
XM Satellite Radio (U.S.A. and Canada models only)  
If an operation takes longer than usual or an error occurs, one of the following messages may appear in the front panel  
display. In this case, read the cause and follow the corresponding remedies.  
See  
page  
Status message  
Cause  
Remedy  
The XM Passport and XM Passport Home Check XM Passport and XM Passport Home Dock  
Dock are not connected to the XM jack of connections and orient for the best reception level.  
this unit or do not work properly.  
CHECK ANTENNA  
The XM user encryption code is being  
updated.  
Wait until the encryption code is updated.  
UPDATING  
NO SIGNAL  
LOADING  
OFF AIR  
The signal is too weak.  
Adjust the orientation of the XM Passport System for  
the best reception level.  
It takes longer than four seconds for audio Wait until the decoding process has finished.  
or text data to be decoded.  
The XM Satellite Radio channel you  
selected is not currently broadcasting any  
signals.  
Check the channel number again or select another  
XM Satellite Radio channel.  
The Channel Station ID (SID) is no longer  
available.  
<XM> - - -  
No artist name or song title is available.  
- - - / - - -  
No channels are available for the selected  
category.  
Select another channel category by pressing  
CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/CAT. j/ ion  
the remote control) repeatedly.  
<CAT> - - -  
Remote control  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
The remote control  
does not work or  
function properly.  
Wrong distance or angle.  
The remote control will function within a maximum  
range of 6 m (20 ft) and no more than 30 degrees off-  
axis from the front panel.  
Direct sunlight or lighting (from an  
inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is  
striking the remote control sensor of this  
unit.  
Reposition this unit.  
The batteries are weak.  
Replace all batteries.  
The batteries do not last long and get  
quickly exhausted.  
Using alkaline batteries is strongly recommended.  
The operation mode selector is set  
incorrectly.  
Set the operation mode selector correctly.  
When operating this unit, set it to the AMP position.  
When operating the component selected by the input  
selector button, set it to the SOURCE position.  
When operating the TV set in the DTV or PHONO  
area, set it to the TV position.  
The remote control code was not correctly Set the remote control code correctly using  
set.  
“LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at the end  
of this manual.  
Try setting another code of the same manufacturer  
using “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at  
the end of this manual.  
The library code of the remote control and Match the remote control ID of this unit with the  
the remote control ID of this unit do not  
match.  
corresponding remote control library code.  
143 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
The remote control  
does not work or  
function properly.  
Even if the remote control code is  
correctly set, there are some models that  
do not respond to the remote control.  
Program the necessary functions independently into  
the programmable buttons using the Learn feature.  
The remote control  
does not learn new  
functions.  
The batteries of this remote control and/or Replace the batteries.  
the other remote control are too weak.  
The distance between the two remote  
controls is too much or too little.  
Place the remote controls at the proper distance.  
The signal coding or modulation of the  
other remote control is not compatible  
with this remote control.  
Learning is not possible.  
Memory capacity is full.  
Delete other unnecessary functions to make room for  
the new functions.  
HDMI  
See  
page  
Error message  
Device Over  
Cause  
Remedy  
The number of the connected HDMI  
components is over the limit.  
Reduce the number of the connected HDMI  
components.  
Check that the connected HDMI components support  
the HDCP copy protection standards.  
HDCP Error  
HDCP authentication failed.  
Network and USB  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
The PC server/MCX-2000/  
Internet Radio does not  
function properly.  
The IP address is not set properly.  
Set the DHCP server function of the router to ON.  
Alternately, perform manual configuration  
according to the current operating environment.  
The network cable is not connected.  
Connect it properly.  
The music in the PC  
server cannot be played  
back.  
The PC does not have Windows Media  
Connect 2.0 installed in it.  
Install Windows Media Connect 2.0 in the PC.  
The music is recorded in a format that  
cannot be played on this unit. This unit  
cannot play music formats other than  
WMA, MP3 and WAV (PCM format).  
Also note that it cannot play certain  
music files even if these are recorded in  
the WMA, MP3 or WAV format.  
Play music recorded in a format that this unit is  
compatible with.  
The music is copyright-protected.  
This unit cannot play copyright-protected music.  
Windows Media Connect  
2.0 cannot be connected.  
The Windows XP PC is logging on to a  
domain.  
Log on to the local machine instead of the  
domain.  
The MusicCAST server  
cannot be connected.  
You are attempting to connect to  
MCX-1000. The MusicCAST server that  
can be connected by this unit is  
MCX-2000.  
Use MCX-2000 or the PC server.  
Execute “Auto Configure”.  
Auto Configuration is not executed.  
144 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
“Disconnected” is  
displayed even when a  
USB device is present.  
This unit recognized the USB device as  
an illegal device.  
Turn this unit off then on again.  
The Internet Radio cannot The firewall of the network device is  
Check the firewall setting of the network device.  
be played.  
activated. The Internet Radio can be  
played only when it passes through the  
port designated by each radio station.  
The port number is variable depending  
on radio station.  
Connection to the Internet is  
disconnected.  
Check the configuration of the network device,  
and then contact the network connection provider.  
The music files and  
directories in the USB  
device cannot be viewed.  
The music files and directories are placed Place music files and directories in the FAT area.  
in locations other than the FAT area.  
You are attempting to browse directory  
hierarchies of over 8 levels or a directory  
with more than 500 files.  
Modify the data structure on your USB device.  
The USB device cannot  
be recognized.  
The connected USB device is other than  
a USB mass storage class USB memory  
device or USB portable audio player.  
This unit can recognize only a USB mass storage  
class USB memory device or USB portable audio  
player. Also note that it cannot recognize certain  
USB devices even when they are devices as  
described above.  
Some devices may become easier to recognize  
when they are inserted before turning this unit on.  
This unit does not recall  
the correct item by using  
numeric buttons (1-8).  
The connected USB device is incorrect.  
Connect the USB device that stores the preset  
item.  
The directory that stores the selected item Preset the desired item to the numeric button (1-8)  
is changed.  
again.  
This unit does not recall  
the selected item by using correctly.  
numeric buttons (1-8).  
The USB device is not connected  
Connect the correct USB device properly.  
The PC or MCX-2000 that stores the  
selected item is turned off.  
Turn on the PC or MCX-2000.  
The selected Internet Radio station is  
temporary unavailable or out of service.  
Try again when the selected Internet Radio is  
providing the service.  
Preset other Internet Radio stations.  
See  
page  
Status message  
Please wait  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit is in the middle of recognizing  
the connection with your network.  
This is not a system malfunction. Wait for a  
while.  
This unit is in the middle of recognizing  
the connection with your USB memory  
device or USB portable audio player.  
This is not a system malfunction. Wait for a  
while.  
This unit is in the middle of waking up  
MCX-2000 that has been set to the  
standby mode.  
Wait for approximately 20 seconds.  
Please wait  
(Starting Server)  
145 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Status message  
Connect error  
Cause  
Remedy  
There is a problem with the signal path  
from your network to this unit.  
Check the connection between this unit and the  
LAN port on your router or hub.  
Make sure your router is properly connected and  
turned on. Also, make sure your modem is  
properly connected and turned on when you are  
attempting to listen to Internet Radio.  
Your USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player has been  
disconnected from the USB port of this  
unit.  
Check the connection between this unit and your  
USB memory device or USB portable audio  
player.  
Disconnected  
The PC server or MCX-2000 previously  
connected to this unit no longer exists.  
Connect this unit to the available PC server or  
MCX-2000.  
There is a problem with the signal path  
from your USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player to this unit.  
Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB  
memory device or USB portable audio player to  
the USB port of this unit.  
Try resetting your USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player.  
This unit cannot access your USB  
memory device or USB portable audio  
player.  
Try another USB memory device or USB portable  
audio player.  
Access error  
There is a problem with the signal path  
from your USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player to this unit.  
Turn off this unit and reconnect your USB  
memory device or USB portable audio player to  
the USB port of this unit.  
Try resetting your USB memory device or USB  
portable audio player.  
Unable to play  
This unit cannot play back the songs  
currently stored on your PC.  
Make sure Windows Media Connect 2.0 is  
installed on your PC.  
Check that the songs currently stored on your PC  
are playable (MP3, WMA, and WAV).  
Store some other playable music files (MP3,  
WMA, and WAV) on your PC.  
The network may be overloaded with  
Try preparing a network exclusively for use with  
heavy traffic, and playback is interrupted. this unit to separate it from general network  
traffic.  
List updated  
The list of the contents stored on your PC  
server or MCX-2000 has been updated.  
The desired Internet Radio station has  
been added to the “Bookmarks” list.  
Bookmark ON  
Bookmark OFF  
The stored Internet Radio station has  
been removed from the “Bookmarks”  
list.  
No items are assigned to the selected  
numeric button.  
Assign the desired item to the numeric button.  
Empty Memory!  
Not found!  
This unit cannot find the assigned item  
for the selected numeric button.  
Connect the USB device that stores the preset  
item.  
Turn on the PC or MCX-2000.  
Try again when the selected Internet Radio is  
providing the service.  
Preset the desired item to the numeric button (1-8)  
again.  
146 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
iPod  
Note  
In case of a transmission error without a status message appearing in the front panel and on the video monitor, check the connection to  
your iPod (see page 29).  
See  
page  
Status message  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit is in the middle of recognizing  
the connection with your iPod.  
Loading...  
This unit is in the middle of acquiring  
song lists from your iPod.  
There is a problem with the signal path  
from your iPod to this unit.  
Turn off this unit and reconnect the YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock to the DOCK terminal of this unit.  
Connect error  
Try resetting your iPod.  
The iPod being used is not supported by  
this unit.  
Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod  
mini are supported.  
Unknown iPod  
Your iPod is properly stationed in a  
YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as  
the YDS-10, sold separately) connected to  
the DOCK terminal of this unit, and the  
connection between your iPod and this  
unit is complete.  
iPod connected  
Your iPod was removed from a YAMAHA Station your iPod back in a YAMAHA iPod universal  
iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10 sold dock (such as YDS-10 sold separately) connected to  
Disconnected  
separately) connected to the DOCK  
terminal of this unit.  
the DOCK terminal of this unit.  
This unit cannot play back the songs  
currently stored on your iPod.  
Check that the songs currently stored on your iPod  
are playable.  
Unable to play  
Store some other playable music files on your iPod.  
Auto Setup  
Before Auto Setup  
See  
page  
Error message  
Connect MIC!  
Cause  
Remedy  
Optimizer microphone is not connected.  
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
Unplug Phones!  
No Setup Menu!  
Memory Guard!  
Headphones are connected.  
Unplug the headphones.  
All setup menu are set to “Skip”.  
“Memory Guard” is set to “On”.  
Set the desired menu item to “Check”.  
Set “Memory Guard” to “Off”.  
147 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
TROUBLESHOOTING  
During Auto Setup  
See  
page  
Error message  
Cause  
Remedy  
E01:No Front SP  
E02:No Sur. SP  
E03:No PRNS SP  
E04:SBR->SBL  
Front L/R channel signals are not detected.  
A surround channel signal is not detected.  
A presence channel signal is not detected.  
Check the front L/R speaker connections.  
Check the surround speaker connections.  
Check the presence speaker connections.  
Only right surround back channel signal is  
detected.  
Connect the surround back speaker to the  
LEFT SURROUND BACK SPEAKERS  
terminal if you only have one surround  
back speaker.  
E05:Noisy  
Background noise is too loud.  
Try running “Auto Setup” in a quiet  
environment.  
Turn off noisy electric equipment like air  
conditioners or move them away from the  
optimizer microphone.  
E06:Check Sur.  
E07:No MIC  
Surround back speakers are connected,  
though surround L/R speakers are not.  
Connect surround speakers when you use  
surround back speakers.  
The optimizer microphone was unplugged  
during the “Auto Setup” procedure.  
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
E08:No Signal  
The optimizer microphone does not detect  
test tones.  
Check the microphone setting.  
Check the speaker connections and  
placement.  
E09:User Cancel  
The “Auto Setup” procedure was cancelled Run “Auto Setup” again.  
due to user activity.  
E10:Internal Err.  
An internal error occurred.  
Run “Auto Setup” again.  
After Auto Setup  
See  
page  
Warning message  
W1:Out of Phase  
Cause  
Remedy  
Speaker polarity is not correct. This  
message may appear depending on the  
speakers even when the speakers are  
connected correctly.  
Check the speaker connections for proper  
polarity (+ or –).  
W2:Over Distance  
W3:Level Error  
The distance between the speaker and the  
listening position is over 24 m (80 ft).  
Bring the speaker closer to the listening  
position.  
The difference of volume level among  
speakers is excessive.  
Readjust the speaker installation so that all  
speakers are set in locations with similar  
conditions.  
Check the speaker connections.  
Use speakers of similar quality.  
Adjust the output volume of the subwoofer.  
W4:SP Mismatch  
The result of the wiring check of “Auto  
Setup” is different from “Speaker Set” in  
“Manual Setup”.  
Use “Speaker Set” in “Manual Setup” to  
adjust the speaker settings manually.  
Notes  
• If the “ERROR” or “WARNING” screens appears, check the cause of the problem, then run “Auto Setup” again.  
• If warning “W1” appears, corrections are made, but they may not be optimal.  
• If warning “W2” or “W3” appears, no corrections are made.  
• If error “E10” occurs repeatedly, please contact a qualified YAMAHA service center.  
148 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RESETTING THE SYSTEM  
RESETTING THE SYSTEM  
Use this feature to reset all the parameters of this unit to the initial factory settings.  
Notes  
• This procedure completely resets all the parameters of this unit. However, the advanced setup menu parameters will not be initialized.  
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on this unit.  
y
To cancel the initialization procedure at any time without making any changes, press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to release it  
outward to the OFF position.  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select “PRESET”.  
(U.S.A. model)  
PURE DIRECT  
VOLUME  
AUDIO  
SELECT  
TONE  
CONTROL  
REC OUT/  
ZONE2 A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/  
TUNING  
MEMORY  
FM/AM MAN'L/AUTO FM  
TUNING  
MODE  
PRESET/TUNING  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
EDIT  
INPUT  
STRAIGHT  
ZONE ON/OFF  
ZONE CONTROLS  
OPTICAL  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
MULTI ZONE  
EFFECT  
ZONE  
L
2
ZONE  
3
YPAO  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
PROGRAM  
PROGRAM  
OPTIMIZER  
MIC  
PHONES  
VIDEO AUX  
USB  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
3
2,4  
1-2,5  
USERꢀPRESET  
CANCEL  
1
2
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to turn  
off this unit.  
4
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to select “RESET”.  
MASTER  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
While holding  
USERꢀPRESET  
RESET  
down  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
y
Select “CANCEL” to cancel the initialization procedure  
without making any changes.  
5
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to  
confirm your selection and turn off this unit.  
MASTER  
149 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
GLOSSARY  
GLOSSARY  
Bi-amplification connection  
Dolby Digital  
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a  
speaker. One amplifier is connected to the woofer section  
of a loudspeaker while the other is connected to the  
combined mid and tweeter section. With this arrangement  
each amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range.  
This restricted range presents each amplifier with a much  
simpler job and each amplifier is less likely to influence  
the sound in some way. The internal crossover of the  
speaker consists of a LPF (low pass filter) and a HPF (high  
pass filter). As its name implies, the LPF passes  
frequencies below a cutoff and rejects frequencies above  
the cutoff frequency. Likewise, the HPF passes  
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives  
you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3  
front channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround  
stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio  
channels. With an additional channel especially for bass  
effects, called LFE (Low Frequency Effect), the system  
has a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1  
channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround  
speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and  
surround sound environment are possible than with Dolby  
Surround. The wide dynamic range from maximum to  
minimum volume reproduced by the 5 full-range channels  
and the precise sound orientation generated using digital  
sound processing provide listeners with unprecedented  
excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound  
environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel  
configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment.  
frequencies above its cutoff.  
Component video signal  
With the component video signal system, the video signal  
is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the PB  
and PR signals for the chrominance. Color can be  
reproduced more faithfully with this system because each  
of these signals is independent. The component signal is  
also called the “color difference signal” because the  
luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A  
monitor with component input jacks is required in order to  
output component signals.  
Dolby Digital EX  
Dolby Digital EX creates 6 full-bandwidth output  
channels from 5.1-channel sources. This is done using a  
matrix decoder that derives 3 surround channels from the  
2 in the original recording. For the best results, Dolby  
Digital EX should be used with movie sound tracks  
recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. With this  
additional channel, you can experience more dynamic and  
realistic moving sound especially with scenes with “fly-  
over” and “fly-around” effects.  
Composite video signal  
With the composite video signal system, the video signal  
is composed of three basic elements of a video picture:  
color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite  
video jack on a video component transmits these three  
elements combined.  
Dolby Pro Logic II  
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to  
decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources.  
This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel  
playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center  
channel, and 2 surround left and right channels instead of  
only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic  
technology. There are three modes available: “Music  
mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie  
sources and “Game mode” for game sources.  
Dialogue normalization  
Dialogue Normalization is a feature of Dolby Digital or  
DTS, which is used to keep the programs at the same  
average listening level so the user does not have to change  
the volume control between Dolby Digital or DTS  
programs.  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete  
multi-channel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel  
sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode”  
for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources (for  
2-channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game  
sources.  
150 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
Dolby Surround  
HDMI  
Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system  
to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front  
left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog  
(monaural), and a surround channel for special sound  
effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces  
sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is  
widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs,  
and in many TV and cable broadcasts as well. The Dolby  
Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital  
signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the  
volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects  
and directionality.  
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first  
industry-supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video  
interface. Providing an interface between any source (such  
as a set-top box or AV receiver) and an audio/video  
monitor (such as a digital television), HDMI supports  
standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as  
multi-channel digital audio using a single cable. HDMI  
transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and supports 8-  
channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to  
accommodate future enhancements and requirements.  
When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth  
Digital Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure  
audio/video interface that meets the security requirements  
of content providers and system operators. For further  
information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at  
“http://www.hdmi.org/”.  
DSD  
Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio  
signals on digital storage media, such as Super Audio  
CDs. Using DSD, signals are stored as single bit values at  
a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while  
noise shaping and oversampling are used to reduce  
distortion, a common occurrence with very high  
quantization of audio signals. Due to the high sampling  
rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered  
by the PCM format used for normal audio CDs.  
LFE 0.1 channel  
This channel reproduces low-frequency signals. The  
frequency range of this channel is from 20 Hz to 120 Hz.  
This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a  
low-frequency range compared to the full-range  
reproduced by the other 5/6 channels in Dolby Digital or  
DTS 5.1/6.1-channel systems.  
DTS 96/24  
MP3  
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality  
for multi-channel sound on DVD video, and is fully  
backward-compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers  
to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz  
sampling rate. “24” refers to 24-bit word length.  
DTS 96/24 offers sound quality transparent to the original  
96/24 master, and 96/24 5.1-channel sound with full-  
quality full-motion video for music programs and motion  
picture soundtracks on DVD video.  
One of the audio compression methods used by MPEG. It  
employs the irreversible compression method, which  
achieves a high compression rate by thinning out the data  
of hardly audible part to the human ears. It is said to be  
capable of compressing the data quantity by about 1/11  
(128 kbps) while maintaining a similar audio quality to  
music CD.  
Neo:6  
DTS (Digital Theater Systems)  
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-  
channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables  
playback with the full-range channels with higher  
separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There  
are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources  
and “Cinema mode” for movie sources.  
Digital Surround  
DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog  
soundtracks of movies with a 6.1-channel digital sound  
track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie  
theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc.  
has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy  
the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of  
DTS digital surround in your home. This system produces  
practically distortion-free 6.1-channel sound (technically,  
front left and right, center, surround left and right, and  
LFE 0.1 (subwoofer) channels for a total of 5.1 channels).  
This unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1-  
channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel  
to the existing 5.1-channel format.  
Neural Surround  
Neural Surround represents the latest advancement in  
surround technology and has been adopted by XM  
Satellite Radio for digital radio broadcast of surround  
recordings and live events in surround sound. Neural  
Surround employs psychoacoustic frequency domain  
processing which allows delivery of a more detailed sound  
stage with superior channel separation and localization of  
audio elements. System playback is scalable from 5.1 to  
7.1 multi-channel surround playback.  
151 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
PCM (Linear PCM)  
S-video signal  
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog  
audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without  
using any compression. This is used as a method of  
recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a  
technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per  
very small unit of time. Standing for “Pulse Code  
Modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and  
then modulated for recording.  
With the S-video signal system, the video signal normally  
transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted  
as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the  
chrominance through the S-video cable. Using the  
S VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss  
and allows recording and playback of even more beautiful  
images.  
WAV  
Sampling frequency and number of  
quantized bits  
Windows standard audio file format, which defines the  
method of recording the digital data obtained by  
converting audio signals. It does not specify the  
compression (coding) method so a desired compression  
method can be used with it. By default, it is compatible  
with the PCM method (no compression) and some  
compression methods including the ADPCM method.  
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of  
times the signal is sampled per second is called the  
sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when  
converting the sound level into a numeric value is called  
the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can  
be played back is determined based on the sampling rate,  
while the dynamic range representing the sound level  
difference is determined by the number of quantized bits.  
In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider  
the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the  
higher the number of quantized bits, the more finely the  
sound level can be reproduced.  
WMA  
An audio compression method developed by Microsoft  
Corporation. It employs the irreversible compression  
method, which achieves a high compression rate by  
thinning out the data of hardly audible part to the human  
ears. It is said to be capable of compressing the data  
quantity by about 1/22 (64 kbps) while maintaining a  
similar audio quality to music CD.  
152 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM INFORMATION  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM INFORMATION  
Elements of a sound field  
SILENT CINEMA  
What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument  
are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In  
addition to making the sound live, these reflections enable  
us to tell where the player is situated as well as the size  
and shape of the room in which we are sitting.  
There are two distinct types of sound reflections that  
combine to make up the sound field in addition to the  
direct sound coming straight to our ears from the player’s  
instrument.  
YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect  
DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for  
headphones have been set for each sound field so that  
accurate representations of all the sound field programs  
can be enjoyed on headphones.  
Virtual CINEMA DSP  
YAMAHA has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP  
algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field  
surround effects even without any surround speakers by  
using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to  
enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker  
system that does not include a center speaker.  
Early reflections  
Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms  
to 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one  
surface only (for example, from a wall or the ceiling).  
Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound.  
Sound output from each speaker  
Sound output from each speaker depends on the type of  
audio signals being input. Refer to the diagrams in the  
table below to understand the speaker layout for each  
sound field program. For details about the sound output  
from each speaker in sound field programs, refer to  
“SOUND OUTPUT IN EACH SOUND FIELD  
Reverberations  
These are caused by reflections from more than one  
surface (for example, from the walls, and the ceiling) so  
numerous that they merge together to form a continuous  
sonic afterglow. They are non-directional and lessen the  
clarity of the direct sound.  
PROGRAM” in “APPENDIX” at the end of this manual.  
Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent  
reverberations taken together help us to determine the  
subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this  
information that the digital sound field processor  
reproduces in order to create sound fields.  
Note  
Be advised that there may be no or not enough sound output from  
speakers depending on the type of input source being played  
back. Furthermore, there may be some channels that can only be  
used partially when they are adjusted to specific aspects of  
movies, such as special sound effects, etc.  
If you could create the appropriate early reflections and  
subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you  
would be able to create your own listening environment.  
The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a  
concert hall, a dance floor, or a room with virtually any  
size at all. This ability to create sound fields at will is  
exactly what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound  
field processor.  
y
Except for “2ch Stereo”, “7ch Stereo”, and “STRAIGHT”, you  
can select a decoder to output sound from the surround back  
CINEMA DSP  
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were  
originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect  
is best felt in a theater having many speakers designed for  
acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room  
size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can  
differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in  
the sound heard. Based on a wealth of actually measured  
data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses YAMAHA original  
sound field technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic,  
Dolby Digital and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual  
experience of a movie theater in the listening room of your  
own home.  
153 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER INFORMATION  
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER INFORMATION  
This unit employs YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic  
Optimizer (YPAO) technology, together with the  
Parametric EQ settings (see page 98), to optimize the  
frequency characteristics of its parametric equalizer to  
match your listening environment. YPAO uses a  
combination of the following three parameters  
Q factor  
The width of the specified frequency band is referred to as  
the Q factor. This parameter is adjustable between the  
values 0.5 and 10.  
(Frequency, Gain and Q factor) to provide highly precise  
adjustment of the frequency characteristics.  
Frequency  
This parameter is adjustable in one-third octave  
increments between 32 Hz and 16 kHz.  
YPAO adjusts frequency characteristics to suit your  
listening requirements using a combination of the above  
three parameters (Frequency, Gain and Q factor) for each  
equalizer band in this unit’s parametric equalizer. This unit  
has 7 equalizer bands for each channel.  
The use of multiple equalizer bands enables more precise  
adjustments of frequency characteristics (as in Figure 2).  
This is not possible using only a single equalizer band (as  
in Figure 1).  
Gain  
This parameter is adjustable in increments of 0.5 dB  
between –20 and +6 dB.  
Figure 1  
Gain  
Frequency  
characteristic after  
correction  
Band 1  
Frequency  
Original frequency  
characteristic  
Figure 2  
Gain  
Frequency  
characteristic after  
correction  
Band 1  
Frequency  
Original frequency  
characteristic  
Band 2  
154 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPECIFICATIONS  
SPECIFICATIONS  
• Tone Control (Front L/R)  
AUDIO SECTION  
BASS Boost/Cut ........................................................ 6 dB/50 Hz  
BASS Turnover Frequency .................................. 125/350/500 Hz  
TREBLE Boost/Cut ................................................ 6 dB/20 kHz  
TREBLE Turnover Frequency .............................. 2.5/3.5/8.0 kHz  
• Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround,  
Surround back  
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 .................................... 140 W  
• Dynamic Power (IHF)  
• Zone 2/Zone 3 Tone Control (Front L/R)  
8/6/4/2 ........................................................ 170/205/265/345 W  
BASS Boost/Cut .................................................... 10 dB/100 Hz  
BASS Turnover Frequency .................................................450 Hz  
TREBLE Boost/Cut .............................................. 10 dB/10 kHz  
TREBLE Turnover Frequency ...........................................2.0 kHz  
• Maximum Useful Output Power (JEITA)  
[Asia, General, China and Korea models]  
1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 ........................................................ 185 W  
• Maximum Output Power [U.K. and Europe models]  
• Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)  
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround back) ...........12 dB/oct.  
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .........................................................24 dB/oct.  
1 kHz, 0.7% THD, 4 ....................................................... 200 W  
• Dynamic Headroom  
8 .................................................................................... 0.84 dB  
VIDEO SECTION  
• IEC Output Power [U.K. and Europe models]  
• Video Format [MONITOR OUT] (Wall Paper)  
[U.S.A., Canada, General and Korea models] ............ NTSC/PAL  
[U.K., Europe, Australia, Asia and China models]  
................................................................................... PAL/NTSC  
1 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 ..................................................... 145 W  
• Damping Factor (IHF)  
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 ................................................. 150 or more  
• Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance  
• Video Format (Video Conversion)  
PHONO .................................................................. 3.5 mV/47 kΩ  
CD, etc. ................................................................. 200 mV/47 kΩ  
MULTI CH INPUT ............................................... 200 mV/47 kΩ  
..........................................................................................NTSC/PAL  
• Signal Level  
Composite ................................................................. 1 Vp-p/75 Ω  
S-video ............................ 1 Vp-p/75 (Y), 0.286 Vp-p/75 (C)  
Component ................... 1 Vp-p/75 (Y), 0.7 Vp-p/75 (PB/PR)  
• Maximum Input Voltage  
PHONO (1 kHz, 0.1% THD) ................................ 60 mV or more  
CD, etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) .................................. 2.4 V or more  
• Maximum Input Level (Video Conversion Off)  
............................................................................... 1.5 Vp-p or more  
• Rated Output Voltage/Output Impedance  
OUT (REC) ........................................................... 200 mV/900 Ω  
PRE OUT .................................................................. 1.0 V/1.2 kΩ  
SUBWOOFER .......................................................... 2.0 V/1.2 kΩ  
ZONE 2/ZONE 3 OUT ............................................. 1.0 V/1.4 kΩ  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (Video Conversion Off)  
.................................................................................... 60 dB or more  
• Frequency Response [MONITOR OUT]  
Component (Video Conversion Off)  
............................................................. 5 Hz to 100 MHz, 3 dB  
• Headphone Jack Rated Output/Impedance  
CD, etc. (1 kHz, 40 mV, 8 ) ............................... 150 mV/100 Ω  
• Video Format [ZONE OUT] (Gray Back)  
• Frequency Response  
[U.S.A., Canada, General and Korea models] .................... NTSC  
[U.K., Europe, Australia, Asia and China models] ................ PAL  
CD to Front L/R, Pure Direct .......... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, +0/–3 dB  
• RIAA Equalization Deviation  
PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) .......................................... 0 0.5 dB  
FM SECTION  
• Tuning Range  
• Total Harmonic Distortion  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ........................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz  
[Asia and General models] ........ 87.5/87.50 to 108.0/108.00 MHz  
[Other models] ............................................ 87.50 to 108.00 MHz  
PHONO to OUT (REC)  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 1 V) ......................................... 0.02% or less  
CD, etc. to Front L/R  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 70 W, 8 Ω) ............................... 0.04% or less  
• 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity (IHF)  
Mono/Stereo ........................................ 2.0/25 µV (17.3/39.2 dBf)  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)  
PHONO (5 mV) to Front L/R  
• Usable Sensitivity (IHF) ....................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf)  
• Selectivity (400 kHz) .............................................................. 70 dB  
[Australia, U.K. and Europe models] .................... 81 dB or more  
[Other models] ....................................................... 86 dB or more  
CD, etc. (250 mV) to Front L/R .......................... 100 dB or more  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)  
Mono/Stereo .............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB  
• Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)  
Front L/R ............................................................... 150 µV or less  
• Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)  
Mono/Stereo .................................................................... 0.2/0.3%  
• Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz)  
PHONO (shortened) to Front L/R ............... 60 dB/55 dB or more  
CD, etc.  
(5.1 kshortened) to Front L/R ............... 60 dB/45 dB or more  
• Stereo Separation (1 kHz)  
Stereo .....................................................................................42 dB  
• Frequency Response  
Stereo .............................................. 20 Hz to 15 kHz, +0.5, –2 dB  
• Antenna Input (unbalanced) ..................................................... 75 Ω  
155 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SPECIFICATIONS  
AM SECTION  
• Tuning Range  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. 530 to 1710 kHz  
[Asia and General models] ................. 530/531 to 1710/1611 kHz  
[Other models] ................................................... 531 to 1611 kHz  
• Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m  
GENERAL  
• Power Supply  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .............................. AC 120 V, 60 Hz  
[General and Asia model]  
....................................... AC 110/120/220/230–240 V, 50/60 Hz  
[China model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 50 Hz  
[Korea model] .................................................... AC 220 V, 60 Hz  
[Australia model] ............................................... AC 240 V, 50 Hz  
[U.K. and Europe models] ................................. AC 230 V, 50 Hz  
• Power Consumption  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ................................. 500 W/630 VA  
[Other models] ................................................................... 500 W  
• Standby Power Consumption  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .................................... 0.1 W or less  
[General model] (AC 240 V, 50 Hz) ...................... 0.33 W or less  
[Other models] ......................................................... 0.1 W or less  
• Maximum Power Consumption [General model only]  
6ch, 10% THD ................................................................. 1100 W  
• AC Outlets  
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .... 2 (Total 100 W/0.8 A maximum)  
[Asia, General and China models] ....... 2 (Total 50 W maximum)  
[Australia and U.K. models] .... 1 (Total 100 W/0.4 A maximum)  
[Europe model] ......................... 2 (Total 100 W/0.4 A maximum)  
• Dimensions (W x H x D) ............................. 435 x 171 x 438.5 mm  
(17.1 x 6.7 x 17.3 in)  
• Weight .................................................................. 17.2 kg (37.9 lbs)  
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
156 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND OUTPUT IN EACH SOUND FIELD PROGRAM  
L
C
R
SL  
SR  
SBL  
SBR  
PL  
PR  
Front left speaker  
Center speaker  
Surround left speaker  
Surround back right speaker  
Presence left speaker  
Surround right speaker  
Surround back left speaker  
Front right speaker  
Presence right speaker  
Speaker from which no sound is being output  
Speaker from which sound is being output  
*1  
*2  
*3  
EX  
EX  
EX  
PL  
PL  
PL  
x
x
x
/
/
/
/
: OFF  
/
/
: ON, PRIORITY: PRNS  
: ON, PRIORITY: SB  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Munich  
Hall in Vienna  
Hall in  
Amsterdam  
Church in  
Freiburg  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Chamber  
LIVE/CLUB  
Village  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
Vanguard  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Warehouse Loft  
Cellar Club  
The Roxy  
Theatre  
The Bottom Line  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Sports  
Music Video  
Recital/Opera  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Action Game  
Roleplaying  
Game  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
MOVIE  
STANDARD  
(PRO LOGIC)  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
/
/
/
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
MOVIE  
STANDARD  
(PLII Movie)  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
(PLIIx Movie)  
(Neo:6 Cinema)  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PRIORITY: PRNS  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
/
/
/
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
PRIORITY: SB  
MOVIE  
Spectacle  
Sci-Fi  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Adventure  
Drama  
Mono Movie  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
STEREO  
2ch Stereo  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
STEREO  
7ch Stereo  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
SURROUND DECODE  
PRO LOGIC  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PRO LOGIC  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Dolby Digital  
/
DTS  
SURROUND DECODE  
PLII Movie  
PLII Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
PLII Game  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Movie/Game  
Movie/Music/Game  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
SURROUND DECODE  
PLIIx Movie  
PLIIx Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
PLIIx Game  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Movie/Game  
Movie/Music/Game  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
SURROUND DECODE  
Neo:6 Cinema  
Neo:6 Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Cinema  
Cinema/Music  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
SURROUND DECODE  
neural sur.  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
STRAIGHT  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
PURE DIRECT  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GPL/LGPL  
these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this License.  
(Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but does not normally print  
such an announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to  
print an announcement.)  
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE  
Version 2, June 1991  
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 59 Temple Place, Suite 330,  
Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim  
copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.  
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections  
of that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered  
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do  
not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when  
you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the  
Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License,  
whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each  
and every part regardless of who wrote it.  
Preamble  
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and  
change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your  
freedom to share and change free software–to make sure the software is free for all its  
users. This General Public License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation’s  
software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other Free  
Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License  
instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.  
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work  
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the  
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program.  
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the  
Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution  
medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.  
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General  
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute  
copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source  
code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in  
new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.  
3.  
You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section 2)  
in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above  
provided that you also do one of the following:  
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you  
these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain  
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.  
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source  
code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on  
a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,  
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you  
must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too,  
receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know  
their rights.  
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any  
third party, for a charge no more than your cost of physically performing  
source distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the corresponding  
source code, to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a  
medium customarily used for software interchange; or,  
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this  
license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software.  
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute  
corresponding source code. (This alternative is allowed only for  
noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object  
code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b  
above.)  
Also, for each author’s protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone  
understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified  
by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is  
not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the  
original authors’ reputations.  
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making  
modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source  
code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the  
scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a  
special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally  
distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler,  
kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that  
component itself accompanies the executable.  
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid  
the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses,  
in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any  
patent must be licensed for everyone’s free use or not licensed at all.  
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.  
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND  
MODIFICATION  
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a  
designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same  
place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not  
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.  
0.  
This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed  
by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this  
General Public License. The “Program”, below, refers to any such program or  
work, and a “work based on the Program” means either the Program or any  
derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program  
or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into  
another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the  
term “modification”.) Each licensee is addressed as “you”.  
4.  
5.  
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as  
expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,  
sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate  
your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or  
rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long  
as such parties remain in full compliance.  
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this  
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted, and  
the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on  
the Program (independent of having been made by running the Program). Whether that  
is true depends on what the Program does.  
You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it.  
However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program  
or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept  
this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Program (or any work  
based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and  
all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or  
works based on it.  
1.  
You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program’s source code as you  
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately  
publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty;  
keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any  
warranty; and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License  
along with the Program.  
6.  
7.  
Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the Program), the  
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,  
distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may  
not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the rights granted  
herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this  
License.  
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your  
option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.  
2.  
You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus  
forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications  
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of  
these conditions:  
If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or  
for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you  
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of  
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you  
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this  
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not  
distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit  
royalty-free redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies directly  
or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this  
License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.  
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you  
changed the files and the date of any change.  
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in  
part contains or is derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be  
licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this  
License.  
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run,  
you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most  
ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate  
copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that  
you provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under  
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular  
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole  
is intended to apply in other circumstances.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other  
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole  
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is  
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous  
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance  
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or  
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot  
impose that choice.  
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author Gnomovision comes with  
ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’. This is free software, and  
you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type ‘show c’ for details.  
The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts  
of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may be called  
something other than ‘show w’ and ‘show c’; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu  
items–whatever suits your program.  
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if  
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample;  
alter the names:  
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence  
of the rest of this License.  
8.  
If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries  
either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who  
places the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical  
distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted  
only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License  
incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License.  
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program  
‘Gnomovision’ (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.  
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989  
Ty Coon, President of Vice  
This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into  
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more  
useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you  
want to do, use the GNU Library General Public License instead of this License.  
9.  
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the  
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in  
spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or  
concerns.  
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a  
version number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the  
option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later  
version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a  
version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free  
Software Foundation.  
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE  
Version 2.1, February 1999  
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.  
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA  
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose  
distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For  
software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free  
Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will  
be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our  
free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.  
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document,  
but changing it is not allowed.  
[This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of  
the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.]  
Preamble  
NO WARRANTY  
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change  
it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to  
share and change free software–to make sure the software is free for all its users.  
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS  
NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY  
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING  
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE  
PROGRAM “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND  
PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE  
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL  
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.  
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated  
software packages–typically libraries–of the Free Software Foundation and other  
authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully  
about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy  
to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.  
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price. Our General  
Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of  
free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can  
get it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of it in new free  
programs; and that you are informed that you can do these things.  
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED  
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER  
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS  
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING  
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE  
PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR  
DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY  
YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO  
OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR  
OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH  
DAMAGES.  
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you  
these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to certain  
responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.  
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must  
give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too,  
receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must  
provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the  
library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them  
these terms so they know their rights.  
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS  
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and (2) we  
offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or  
modify the library.  
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs  
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the  
public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can  
redistribute and change under these terms.  
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that there is no warranty for  
the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the  
recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the  
original author’s reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced  
by others.  
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the  
start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each  
file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is  
found.  
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program. We  
wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free program  
by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that any  
patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full  
freedom of use specified in this license.  
<one line to give the program’s name and a brief idea of what it does.>  
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>  
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the  
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software  
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.  
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General  
Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain  
designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We  
use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non-  
free programs.  
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY  
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or  
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public  
License for more details.  
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the  
combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original  
library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the  
entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public License  
permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library.  
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with  
this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place,  
Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA.  
We call this license the “Lesser” General Public License because it does Less to protect the  
user’s freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free  
software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These  
disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries.  
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.  
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an  
interactive mode:  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special circumstances.  
written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the  
distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library.  
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest  
possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this,  
non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free  
library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little to  
gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser General  
Public License.  
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library  
(or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium  
does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.  
3.  
You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License  
instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all  
the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU  
General Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version  
than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then  
you can specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change  
in these notices.  
In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free programs enables a  
greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission  
to use the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many more people to use the  
whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system.  
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users’ freedom, it  
does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom  
and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library.  
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary  
GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works  
made from that copy.  
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. Pay  
close attention to the difference between a “work based on the library” and a “work that  
uses the library”. The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter  
must be combined with the library in order to run.  
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a  
program that is not a library.  
4.  
You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under  
Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2  
above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-  
readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and  
2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange.  
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND  
MODIFICATION  
0.  
This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which  
contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying  
it may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also  
called “this License”). Each licensee is addressed as “you”.  
If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated  
place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place  
satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not  
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.  
A “library” means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be  
conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and  
data) to form executables.  
5.  
A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is  
designed to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a  
“work that uses the Library”. Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of  
the Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.  
The “Library”, below, refers to any such software library or work which has been  
distributed under these terms. A “work based on the Library” means either the Library  
or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library  
or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated  
straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without  
limitation in the term “modification”.)  
However, linking a “work that uses the Library” with the Library creates an executable  
that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the Library), rather  
than a “work that uses the library”. The executable is therefore covered by this License.  
Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables.  
“Source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making  
modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all  
modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used  
to control compilation and installation of the library.  
When a “work that uses the Library” uses material from a header file that is part of the  
Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even  
though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work  
can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this  
to be true is not precisely defined by law.  
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this  
License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is  
not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute  
a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing  
it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that  
uses the Library does.  
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and  
accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then  
the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative  
work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall  
under Section 6.)  
1.  
You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library’s complete source  
code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and  
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and  
disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to  
the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the  
Library.  
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code  
for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also  
fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.  
6.  
As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or link a “work that  
uses the Library” with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the  
Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the  
terms permit modification of the work for the customer’s own use and reverse  
engineering for debugging such modifications.  
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your  
option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.  
2.  
You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus  
forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications  
or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of  
these conditions:  
You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it  
and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy of  
this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must include  
the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the  
user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things:  
a) The modified work must itself be a software library.  
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable  
source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the  
work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the  
work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machine-  
readable “work that uses the Library”, as object code and/or source code, so  
that the user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified  
executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that the user  
who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not  
necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified  
definitions.)  
b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you  
changed the files and the date of any change.  
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third  
parties under the terms of this License.  
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be  
supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an  
argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good  
faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such  
function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its  
purpose remains meaningful.  
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A  
suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library  
already present on the user’s computer system, rather than copying library  
functions into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified  
version of the library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version  
is interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with.  
(For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is  
entirely well-defined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires  
that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if  
the application does not supply it, the square root function must still compute square  
roots.)  
c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give  
the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no  
more than the cost of performing this distribution.  
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of  
that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered  
independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not  
apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you  
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the  
distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for  
other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of  
who wrote it.  
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a  
designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified  
materials from the same place.  
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a version  
number of this License which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the option  
of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version  
published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library does not specify a license  
version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software  
Foundation.  
e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you  
have already sent this user a copy.  
For an executable, the required form of the “work that uses the Library” must include  
any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However,  
as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is  
normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components  
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs,  
unless that component itself accompanies the executable.  
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose  
distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for  
permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,  
write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.  
Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all  
derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of  
software generally.  
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other  
proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a  
contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable  
that you distribute.  
NO WARRANTY  
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO  
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY  
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING  
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE  
LIBRARY “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE  
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND  
PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE  
LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL  
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.  
7.  
You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side-by-side  
in a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License,  
and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of  
the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise  
permitted, and provided that you do these two things:  
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the  
Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed  
under the terms of the Sections above.  
b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a  
work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying  
uncombined form of the same work.  
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED  
TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER  
PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS  
PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING  
ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
8.  
9.  
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except  
as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify,  
sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically  
terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received  
copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses  
terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.  
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE  
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA  
BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR  
THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH  
ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY  
HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.  
You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it.  
However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library  
or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept  
this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work  
based on the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and  
all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or  
works based on it.  
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS  
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries  
If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the  
public, we recommend making it free software that everyone can redistribute and  
change. You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively,  
under the terms of the ordinary General Public License).  
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the  
recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy,  
distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions.  
You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients’ exercise of the  
rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third  
parties with this License.  
To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is safest to attach  
them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of  
warranty; and each file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where  
the full notice is found.  
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or  
for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you  
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of  
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you  
cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this  
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not  
distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit  
royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly  
or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this  
License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library.  
<one line to give the library’s name and a brief idea of what it does.>  
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>  
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the  
terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free  
Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any  
later version.  
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY  
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or  
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General  
Public License for more details.  
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular  
circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole  
is intended to apply in other circumstances.  
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License  
along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59  
Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA  
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other  
property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole  
purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is  
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous  
contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance  
on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or  
she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot  
impose that choice.  
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.  
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if  
any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter  
the names:  
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library ‘Frob’ (a  
library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.  
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence  
of the rest of this License.  
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1990  
Ty Coon, President of Vice  
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either  
by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places  
the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution  
limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or  
among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the  
limitation as if written in the body of this License.  
That’s all there is to it!  
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the  
Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be  
similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new  
problems or concerns.  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES  
CALIFORNIA AUDIO LABS  
SM ELECTRONIC 0757  
CABLE  
ABC  
CD RECORDER  
0056  
SAMSUNG  
SANYO  
SHARP  
0600  
0697  
0657  
0030, 0035  
CARVER  
CYRUS  
DKK  
0184, 0206  
0184  
0027  
KENWOOD  
MARANTZ  
PHILIPS  
0653  
0653  
0653  
2400  
AMERICAST 0926  
BELL SOUTH 0926  
BIRMINGHAM CABLE  
COMMUNICATIONS  
0303  
BRITISH TELECOM 0030  
CABLE & WIRELESS  
1095  
DAERYUNG 0035, 0504, 0904,  
1904  
DIRECTOR  
FILMNET  
SHERWOOD 0797  
SHINSONIC 0560  
DMX ELECTRONICS  
0184  
YAMAHA  
SLIM ART  
SONY  
SYLVANIA  
TATUNG  
TEAC  
0811  
0560, 0891  
0702  
0797  
0598, 0744  
0517  
DENON  
0900  
DVD PLAYER  
ACOUSTIC SOLUTIONS  
DYNAMIC BASS  
0206  
EMERSON  
FISHER  
GENEXXA  
0332  
0206  
0059, 0332  
0757  
ALBA  
AMSTRAD  
0744  
0740  
TECHNICS  
GOODMANS 0332  
GRUNDIG 0184  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0184, 0200  
0059  
THETA DIGITAL  
0598  
0503  
0470  
APEX DIGITAL  
0699, 0744,  
0782, 0821, 0823,  
0857, 1127  
THOMSON  
TOSHIBA  
0549  
0530  
GENERAL INSTRUMENT  
0030, 0303, 0503,  
URBAN CONCEPTS 0530  
HITACHI  
JVC  
BLAUPINKT 0744  
BLUE PARADE  
XBOX  
0549  
0837,  
0099  
0598  
YAMAHA  
0517, 0566, 0572,  
2100  
GOLDSTAR 0171  
HAMLIN  
JERROLD  
KENWOOD  
KRELL  
LXI  
0055, 0064  
0184  
0332  
BUSH  
CENTREX  
0740  
0699  
0036, 0300  
0030, 0303, 0503,  
0837  
0171  
0470  
0027  
ZENITH  
ZEUS  
0530, 0618, 0768  
0811  
CLATRONIC 0815  
CYBERHOME 0741  
LINN  
0184  
LG  
MNET  
MEMOREX  
MOTOROLA 0303, 0503, 0837,  
1133  
NTL  
MCS  
0056  
DVD2000  
DAEWOO  
DANSAI  
0548  
0811, 0797  
0797  
DVD RECORDER  
MAGNAVOX 0184, 0332  
MARANTZ  
MATSUI  
0056, 0184  
0184  
HITACHI  
2815  
DECCA  
0797  
PANASONIC 2800, 2801, 2802  
MEMOREX  
MERIDIAN  
0332  
0184  
DENON  
0517  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
SHARP  
2808  
1095  
0844  
1095  
DIAMOND  
DIGITREX  
EMERSON  
0795  
0699  
0618  
2804, 2805, 2806  
2812, 2813  
2809, 2810, 2811  
2803  
2814  
2807  
NOOS  
ONO  
MICROMEGA 0184  
MIRO  
0027  
SONY  
PVP STEREO VISUAL MATRIX  
0030  
PACE  
MISSION  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
0184  
0184  
0027  
ENTERPRISE 0618  
TOSHIBA  
VICTOR  
YAMAHA  
FISHER  
GE  
GO VIDEO  
0697  
0549, 0744  
0742  
0264, 1087, 1095  
PANASONIC 0027, 0035, 0134  
NSM  
0184  
PARAGON  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
0027  
NAIM  
OPTIMUS  
0184  
0027, 0059, 0064,  
0206, 0332  
GOLDSTAR 0768  
GRADIENTE 0678  
GREENHILL 0744  
LD PLAYER  
0332, 0344  
0171, 0560, 0904,  
1904  
0027  
0027  
0300, 0306  
0027  
0844  
CARVER  
0091  
PANASONIC 0056  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
POLK AUDIO 0184  
PROTON  
QED  
QUAD  
QUASAR  
RCA  
REALISTIC  
REVOX  
ROTEL  
SAE  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
SCOTT  
SEARS  
SHARP  
SIMAUDIO  
GRUNDIG  
HITACHI  
HITEKER  
JVC  
0566  
0600, 0691  
0699  
0585, 0650  
0744  
DENON  
MARANTZ  
0086  
0091  
PULSAR  
QUASAR  
REGAL  
RUNCO  
SAGEM  
SAMSUNG  
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA  
0035, 0504, 0904,  
0184  
0059, 0332  
MITSUBISHI 0086  
NAD  
0086  
0086  
0086  
0091  
0086  
0091  
0228  
0184  
0184  
0184  
0056  
0059, 0206, 0332  
0206  
0184  
0184  
0184  
0184, 0332  
0206  
0332  
0332  
0064  
KLH  
NAGSMI  
OPTIMUS  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
SALORA  
SONY  
KENWOOD  
KOSS  
0517, 0561  
0678  
0027, 0171  
LG  
0768  
LIMIT  
0795  
1904  
1033  
0030  
MAGNAVOX 0530, 0702  
SONY  
MARANTZ  
MEMOREX  
MICO  
0566  
0858  
0750  
TELEFUNKEN  
YAMAHA  
0086  
STARCOM  
SUPERCABLE  
TS  
TELE+1  
TELEWEST  
TORX  
TOSHIBA  
TRANS PX  
UNITED CABLE  
ZENITH  
2200  
0303  
0030  
0470  
1095  
0030  
0027  
0303  
MICROSOFT 0549  
MINTEK 0744  
MITSUBISHI 0548  
MD RECORDER  
KENWOOD  
ONKYO  
SHARP  
0708  
0895  
0888  
MUSTEK  
NESA  
ONKYO  
ORITRON  
PALSONIC  
0757  
0744  
0530  
0678  
0699  
0184  
SONY  
0517  
0030  
SONIC FRONTIERS 0184  
SONY 0027  
YAMAHA  
2500, 2501, 2502  
0027, 0552, 0926  
SYMPHONIC 0332  
TAG MCLAREN  
PANASONIC 0517, 0659, 1389  
RECEIVER (TUNER)  
0184  
PHILIPS  
0530, 0566, 0673,  
0881  
CD PLAYER  
TANDY  
0059  
0056  
0184  
0184  
ADC  
0558  
AIWA  
0184  
TECHNICS  
THORENS  
THULE  
PIONEER  
0552, 0598, 0658,  
0659  
AIWA  
0185, 1116, 1415,  
1432, 1668  
1417  
ARCAM  
0184  
AUDIO RESEARCH 0184  
AUDIO TON 0184  
POLK AUDIO 0566  
ALCO  
UNIVERSUM 0184  
PROSCAN  
QWESTAR  
RCA  
0549  
0678  
0549, 0598, 0744  
0650  
ANAM  
1636  
AUDIOLAB  
AUDIOMECA 0184  
CAIRN 0184  
0184  
VICTOR  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
0099  
0184  
2300, 2301  
APEX DIGITAL  
AUDIOLAB  
AUDIOTRONIC  
1284  
1216  
ROTEL  
1216  
AUDIOVOX 1417  
BOSE 1256  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CAMBRIDGE SOUNDWORKS  
1397  
CAPETRONIC 0558  
ASTRO  
ATSAT  
AVALON  
0200  
1327  
0423  
ORBITECH  
PACE  
1127  
0482, 0874, 1202,  
1350  
TV  
AGB  
0543  
CARVER  
CENTREX  
DENON  
FERGUSON 0558  
FINE ARTS  
GRUNDIG  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0137, 1331  
INTEGRA  
JBL  
1116, 1216  
1284  
1387  
BLAUPUNKT 0200  
BRITISH SKY BROADCASTING  
0874, 1202  
PANASONIC 0274, 0728, 0874,  
1347  
AOC  
0036, 0057, 0087,  
0119, 0120, 0135,  
0205, 0207, 0478  
0131  
0036  
0036  
0119, 0135, 0680  
0120, 0190, 0490  
0788  
PANDA  
PAYSAT  
PHILIPS  
0482  
0751  
0160, 0227, 0482,  
0749, 0751, 0776,  
0880, 1103, 1169,  
1776  
CANAL DIGITAL  
CANAL SATELLITE 0880  
CANAL+ 0880  
CHAPARRAL 0243  
0880  
ASA  
AWA  
1216  
1216  
ACURA  
ADDISON  
ADMIRAL  
ADVENT  
AIKO  
CITYCOM  
1203  
0162, 1325  
0137, 1333  
0101, 0558, 1401,  
1522  
1417, 1439  
1054, 1340  
0066  
CONNEXIONS  
CROSSDIGITAL  
0423  
1136  
PIONEER  
PROMAX  
PROSCAN  
RCA  
0880  
0482  
0419, 0593  
0170, 0419, 0593,  
0882  
0119  
JVC  
CYRUS  
D-BOX  
DMT  
0227  
0750, 1154  
1102  
AKAI  
0036, 0057, 0235,  
0388, 0543, 0729,  
0839  
0291  
0036, 0064, 0398,  
0695  
KLH  
KENWOOD  
MCS  
MAGNAVOX 0558, 1116, 1216,  
1296,  
MARANTZ  
DNT  
0227, 0423  
RFT  
0227  
AKURA  
ALBA  
DAERYUNG 0423  
RADIOSHACK  
RADIOLA  
RADIX  
0896  
DAEWOO  
DIGENIUS  
DIRECTV  
1323  
0326  
0274, 0419, 0593,  
0666, 0751, 0776,  
0846, 1103, 1136,  
1169, 1776, 1883  
0227  
0423  
AMERICA ACTION 0207  
AMPRO  
AMSTRAD  
0066, 1116, 1216,  
1316  
SKY  
0874, 0883, 1202  
0778  
SM ELECTRONIC 1227  
0036, 0064, 0198,  
0398, 0439, 0460,  
0543  
MICROMEGA 1216  
MUSICMAGIC  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
NORCENT  
ONKYO  
OPTIMUS  
PANASONIC 0066, 1315, 1545,  
1790  
SABRE  
0482  
1116  
SAGEM  
SAMSUNG  
0847, 1141, 1280  
1044, 1136, 1303,  
1319  
1216  
0347  
1416  
0162, 0869, 1325  
0558, 1050  
DISH NETWORK SYSTEM  
0802, 1032  
ANAM  
0036, 0207, 0277  
ANAM NATIONAL 0277, 0677  
ANITECH 0036  
APEX DIGITAL  
0794  
AUDIOSONIC 0064, 0136  
BANG & OLUFSEN 0592  
BASIC  
BAUR  
BAYSONIC  
BEAUMARK 0205  
BEKO 0397, 0513, 0741,  
0742  
BELL & HOWELL 0181  
BEON 0064  
BLAUPUNKT 0222  
BLUE SKY  
BONDSTEC 0274  
BRADFORD 0207  
DISHPRO  
0802, 1032  
SAT CONTROL  
1327  
DISTRATEL 0111  
DREAM MULTIMEDIA  
1264  
ECHOSTAR 0194, 0423, 0637,  
0802, 0880, 0898,  
1032, 1113  
SATSTATION 1110  
SCHWAIGER 1138  
0775, 0792,  
SEEMANN  
SIEMENS  
SONY  
STAR CHOICE  
STRONG  
TPS  
0423  
0200  
0666, 0874, 1666  
0896  
1327  
PHILIPS  
1116, 1216, 1293,  
1295, 1296, 1310,  
1316  
0041, 0558, 1050,  
1411  
0036  
0064, 0388, 0539  
0207  
ENGEL  
1044  
PIONEER  
EXPRESSVU 0802  
0847, 1280  
0482  
FTE  
FINLUX  
0890  
0482  
TANTEC  
POLK AUDIO 1316  
TECHNISAT 1126, 1127  
PROSCAN  
QUASAR  
RCA  
1281  
0066  
0558, 1050, 1281,  
1417, 1636,  
0558  
FRACARRO 0898  
TELESTAR  
THOMSON  
1127  
0482, 0880, 1073,  
1318  
FUBA  
GE  
0423  
0593  
GOI  
0802  
TOPFIELD  
TOSHIBA  
ULTIMATETV  
UNIDEN  
1233  
0695, 1064  
SABA  
SANSUI  
GALAXIS  
0890, 1138  
0776, 0817, 1776  
0419, 0666  
0749, 0751  
1116  
GENERAL INSTRUMENT  
0896  
SCHNEIDER 0558  
SONY 0185, 1085, 1185,  
1685, 1785  
STEREOPHONICS 1050  
SUNFIRE  
TEAC  
BRANDT  
BROKSONIC 0263, 0490  
BUSH  
0136, 0362  
GOLD BOX  
GRUNDIG  
HTS  
0880  
0200, 0874  
0802  
UNIVERSUM 0200  
VENTANA  
WISI  
XSAT  
0227  
0200, 0423, 0482  
0150  
0036, 0064, 0398,  
0401, 0695, 1064  
1340  
1417  
0066, 1335, 1336,  
1545  
HIRSCHMANN  
HITACHI  
0200, 0423  
0482, 0846  
CCE  
CGE  
CTC  
CXC  
0064  
0274  
0274  
0207  
0057  
ZEHNDER  
ZENITH  
1102  
0883, 1883  
TECHNICS  
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEM  
0776, 1169, 1776  
TELEFUNKEN  
THOMSON  
THORENS  
UHER  
VENTURER  
VICTOR  
0558  
HUMAX  
INVIDEO  
JVC  
0890, 1203  
0898  
0802  
CANDLE  
CARNIVALE 0057  
TAPE DECK  
1281  
1216  
0558  
1417  
AIWA  
0056  
CARVER  
CASCADE  
CATHAY  
CELEBRITY 0027  
CELERA 0792  
CENTURION 0064  
CHANGHONG 0792  
CHING TAI  
CHUN YUN  
0081, 0197  
0036  
0064  
KATHREIN  
0150, 0200, 0227,  
0276, 0685, 1248  
CARVER  
GRUNDIG  
0056  
0056  
0101  
KREISELMEYER  
0200  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0056  
MAGNAVOX 0056  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
0041, 0185  
0203, 1203, 1358,  
2601  
LABGEAR  
LOGIX  
1323  
1044  
LORENZEN 0326  
MAGNAVOX 0749, 0751  
MARANTZ  
MYRYAD  
OPTIMUS  
PHILIPS  
0056  
0056  
0054  
0056  
0054  
(TUNER ID1)  
(TUNER ID2)  
(XM ID1)  
(XM ID2)  
(iPod)  
2602  
2603  
2604  
2605  
2606  
2607  
0036, 0119  
0027, 0036, 0119,  
0207  
MANHATTAN  
0482, 1044,  
1110  
0227  
0880  
0751  
0111  
MARANTZ  
MEDIASAT  
MEMOREX  
METRONIC  
PIONEER  
CHUNG HSIN 0080, 0135, 0207  
POLK AUDIO 0056  
CIMLINE  
CINERAL  
CITIZEN  
CLARION  
CLARIVOX  
0036  
(NET)  
RCA  
0054  
0119, 0478  
0057, 0087, 0119  
0207  
REVOX  
SANSUI  
SONY  
0056  
0056  
0270  
MITSUBISHI 0776  
MOTOROLA 0896  
SATELLITE TUNER  
0064  
@SAT  
ABSAT  
ALBA  
1327  
0150  
0482  
MYRYAD  
NEXT LEVEL 0896  
NOKIA  
0227  
THORENS  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
0056  
0054  
2700,2701  
CLATRONIC 0274, 0397  
CONDOR  
CONRAC  
0347, 0397  
0835  
0482, 0750, 0778,  
ALPHASTAR 0799  
1154, 1250, 1750  
1032  
AMSTRAD  
ASTON  
0874  
0169, 1156  
OCTALTV  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTEC  
CRAIG  
CROSLEY  
CROWN  
0036, 0207  
0207  
0081  
0036, 0064, 0207,  
0397, 0445  
GRANADA  
0064, 0235, 0366,  
0543  
0637  
0064, 0222, 0514,  
0583, 0614  
0207  
MAGNADYNE  
MAGNAFON 0543  
MAGNAVOX 0057, 0081, 1281,  
1481  
MANESTH  
MARANTZ  
0274, 0543  
PHILIPS  
0027, 0057, 0064,  
0078, 0081, 0119,  
0135, 0205, 0401,  
0583, 0717, 1481  
0064  
GRANDIN  
GRUNDIG  
0291, 0347  
0057, 0064, 0081,  
0583  
PHONOLA  
PILOT  
PIONEER  
CURTIS MATHES 0057, 0074,  
0081, 0087, 0120,  
0172, 0181, 0193,  
0478, 0729, 1174,  
1374  
GRUNPY  
HCM  
HALLMARK 0205  
HANKOOK  
HANSEATIC 0064, 0347, 0388,  
0455, 0583  
HANTAREX 0543  
HARMAN/KARDON 0081  
HARVARD  
HAVERMY  
HELLO KITTY  
HINARI  
0057  
0036, 0439  
0136, 0190, 0193,  
0314, 0706, 0787,  
0893  
MARK  
MATSUI  
0064  
0057, 0205, 0207  
0036, 0064, 0235,  
0398, 0514, 0543  
0277, 0677  
PORTLAND 0119  
PRANDONI-PRINCE  
0543  
PRIMA  
PRISM  
PROFEX  
PROSCAN  
PROTECH  
DAEWOO  
0036, 0057, 0064,  
0119, 0135, 0181,  
0197, 0205, 0207,  
0401, 0478, 0650,  
0661, 1688  
0064  
MATSUSHITA  
MEDIATOR 0064  
MEDION  
MEGATRON 0172, 0205  
0695, 0835, 1064  
0788  
0078  
0207  
0120  
0478  
0036, 0064  
0482  
0036, 0057, 0119,  
0132, 0136, 0172,  
0190, 0205, 0252,  
0383, 0508, 0575,  
0605, 1172, 1283  
0036  
MEMOREX  
0036, 0177, 0181,  
0205, 0277, 0490,  
1064  
0474  
0835  
0036, 0388  
0074  
0036, 0064, 0274,  
0291, 0445, 0695  
0036, 0057, 0205  
0044  
0078, 0277, 0677  
0064, 0131, 0388,  
0539  
DANSAI  
DAYTON  
DE GRAAF  
DECCA  
DENON  
DIGATRON  
DIXI  
DUMONT  
DWIN  
ECE  
ELBE  
ELECTROBAND  
ELIN  
ELITE  
ELTA  
EMERSON  
0036  
0235, 0575  
0064, 0543  
0172  
0064  
0036, 0064  
0044  
0747, 0801  
0064  
0286  
0027  
0064, 0575  
0347  
HISAWA  
HITACHI  
METZ  
MICROMAXX  
MICROSTAR 0835  
MIDLAND  
MINERVA  
MINOKA  
MITSUBISHI 0057, 0120, 0135,  
0177, 0181, 0205,  
PROTON  
PULSAR  
QUASAR  
QUELLE  
0044, 0074, 0078  
0514  
0439  
HUA TUN  
HUANYU  
HYPSON  
ICE  
ITS  
ITT  
IMPERIAL  
INDIANA  
INFINITY  
INGELEN  
INNO HIT  
INNOVA  
INTEQ  
R-LINE  
RCA  
0064  
0401  
0027, 0057, 0074,  
0117, 0119, 0205,  
0706, 1074, 1174,  
1274, 1374, 1474,  
1481, 1574  
0455  
0057, 0074,  
0181, 0205, 0207  
0064  
0543  
0057, 0181, 0205,  
0207  
0388  
0741  
0064, 0291  
0291, 0398  
0398  
0190, 0388, 0575  
0274, 0397, 0445  
0064  
0081  
0190  
0543  
0064  
0207, 0263, 0277,  
0539, 0863, 1277  
0318,0319, 0543,  
0636  
MIVAR  
0036  
MOTOROLA 0120  
MULTITECH 0036, 0207  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
RFT  
RADIOSHACK  
0181, 0205, 0207,  
0263, 0388, 0490,  
0650  
0057,0840  
0860  
0064  
0036, 0057  
0036  
0583  
0183, 0205, 0388,  
0893  
0036, 0057, 0078,  
0181, 0183, 0197,  
0205, 0482, 0524,  
1731  
RADIOLA  
RADIOMARELLI  
REALISTIC  
ENVISION  
EPSON  
ERRES  
ETHER  
ETRON  
NEC  
0044  
INTERFUNK 0064, 0190, 0274,  
0388, 0539  
REDIFFUSION  
REOC  
EUROPHON 0543  
FERGUSON 0064, 0100, 0136,  
0265, 0314, 0362,  
INTERVISION  
0064, 0291,  
NEI  
NTC  
NECKERMANN  
NETSAT  
NEWAVE  
0064  
0119  
REVOX  
REX  
0064  
0190, 0286, 0291  
0404  
0081  
0027  
JBL  
JCB  
JVC  
0064, 0583  
ROADSTAR 0036, 0291, 0445  
RUNCO  
0587  
0064  
0036, 0119, 0120,  
0205  
0044, 0057, 0524,  
0630  
0064  
0291, 0695  
0543  
0064  
0207  
0136, 0190, 0314,  
0362  
0265  
0637  
FIDELITY  
0388  
0080, 0398, 0490,  
0680, 0710  
0036, 0078, 0119,  
0183, 0263  
0788  
FINLANDIA 0235, 0373  
SBR  
SEG  
SEI  
SKY  
SSS  
FINLUX  
0064, 0131, 0132,  
JEAN  
NIKKAI  
NIKKO  
NOKIA  
0064, 0291  
0057, 0119, 0205  
0388, 0500, 0507,  
0575, 0658  
0775, 0851  
0136, 0314,  
0587  
0190, 0388  
0207, 0460  
0181, 0193, 0277,  
0677  
0373, 0543  
0036, 0263  
0036, 0274, 0695  
0131, 0181, 0235,  
0397  
FIRSTAR  
FIRSTLINE  
FISHER  
JENSEN  
KEC  
KTV  
0207  
0057, 0207  
0036  
NORCENT  
NORDMENDE  
SABA  
KAISUI  
FLINT  
0482  
KAPSCH  
KARCHER  
KATHREIN  
KENDO  
KENWOOD  
KNEISSEL  
KOLIN  
KORPEL  
KOYODA  
L&S ELECTRONIC 0835  
0190  
0637  
0583  
0064  
SACCS  
FORMENTI  
FORTRESS  
0064, 0347  
0120  
OCEANIC  
ONWA  
OPTIMUS  
SAGEM  
SAISHO  
SALORA  
0036, 0291, 0543  
0190, 0380, 0388,  
0575  
FRONTECH 0190, 0274, 0291  
FUJITSU  
FUNAI  
FUTURETECH  
GE  
0710, 0836  
0207, 0198, 0291  
0207  
0057, 0074, 0078,  
0119, 0205, 0207,  
0478, 0587, 1174,  
1374, 1481  
0064, 0543  
1782, 1783  
0036  
0057  
0286, 0462  
0080, 0135, 0207  
0064  
OPTONICA  
ORION  
0120  
SAMBERS  
SAMPO  
0543  
0064, 0263, 0347,  
0490, 0543  
0291, 0439  
0036, 0057, 0119,  
0120, 0181, 0198,  
0205, 0677, 1782  
0036, 0057, 0064,  
0087, 0117, 0119,  
0181, 0205, 0291,  
0397, 0583, 0614,  
0645, 0729, 0793,  
0839, 0841  
0478  
0036  
OSAKI  
OTTO VERSAND  
0539, 0583  
PALLADIUM 0397, 0445  
PANAMA 0291  
PANASONIC 0064, 0078, 0081,  
0190, 0277, 0677,  
1437  
PATHE CINEMA  
PAUSA  
PENNEY  
0064, 0347,  
SAMSUNG  
LG  
0057, 0064, 0087,  
GEC  
0135, 0205, 0741  
0074, 0081, 0181,  
0183, 0205  
GATEWAY  
GELOSO  
GENEXXA  
LXI  
0190  
LEYCO  
LIESENK & TTER 0064  
LOEWE  
LUXOR  
M ELECTRONIC  
0064, 0291  
GIBRALTER 0044, 0057  
GOLDSTAR 0057, 0064, 0136,  
0181, 0205, 0404  
GOODMANS 0064, 0398, 0401,  
0661  
SANSEI  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
0539  
0265, 0347  
0490  
0131, 0181, 0207,  
0235, 0366, 0826  
0383, 0388  
0036  
0036, 0064,  
0057, 0074, 0078,  
0087, 0183, 0205,  
1374  
0131, 0132, 0136,  
0190, 0314, 0373,  
0401, 0507  
0057, 0177, 0205  
0057, 0087, 0539  
SCHAUB LORENZ 0388  
SCHNEIDER 0064, 0274, 0398,  
0695  
SCOTCH  
SCOTT  
GOREMJE  
GRADIENTE 0080, 0197  
GRAETZ 0190, 0388  
0397  
PERDIO  
PHILCO  
0347  
MGA  
MTC  
0057, 0064, 0081,  
0172, 0205, 0207,  
0274, 0490, 1688  
0205  
0205, 0207, 0263  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SEARS  
0074, 0081, 0181,  
0183, 0198, 0205  
0190, 0286  
0207  
0183  
UHER  
0347  
COMBITECH 0379  
KAISUI  
KENWOOD  
KODAK  
KOLIN  
KORPEL  
LG  
0099  
UNIVERSUM 0064, 0131, 0132,  
CRAIG  
0064, 0074, 0099,  
0068, 0094  
0062, 0064  
0068, 0070  
0099  
0064, 0069, 0072,  
0507  
SELECO  
SEMIVOX  
SEMP  
SHARP  
SHEN YING 0036, 0119  
0291, 0373, 0397,  
0267  
0519  
VECTOR RESEARCH  
0057  
VESTEL  
VICTOR  
CROWN  
0099, 0305  
CURTIS MATHES 0062, 0068,  
0087, 1062  
CYBERNEX 0267  
0057, 0120, 0677  
0064  
0080, 0277, 0677,  
SHENG CHIA 0036, 0120, 0263  
CYRUS  
0108  
LXI  
0064  
SIAREM  
0543  
0064, 0222  
0543  
0383  
0207  
0680  
0274  
0081  
0205  
DAEWOO  
0072, 0131, 0305,  
0669, 1305  
0099  
0069  
0027, 0108  
0069  
LENCO  
LEYCO  
LLOYD’S  
LOEWE  
LOGIK  
LUXOR  
M ELECTRONIC  
MEI  
MGA  
MGN TECHNOLOGY  
0267  
MTC  
MAGNASONIC  
MAGNAVOX 0027, 0062, 0066,  
0108, 1808  
0305  
0099  
0027  
0064, 0108, 1589  
0099, 0267  
0070, 0075, 0131  
SIEMENS  
SINUDYNE  
SKANTIC  
SKYGIANT  
VIDEOSAT  
VIDIKRON  
VIDTECH  
DANSAI  
DE GRAAF  
DECCA  
DENON  
DUAL  
DUMONT  
DYNATECH 0027  
ESC  
ELCATECH  
VIEWSONIC 1782  
SKYWORTH 0064  
VISION  
0347  
0190  
0383  
0057, 0081, 0205,  
0893  
SOLAVOX  
SONITRON  
SONOKO  
SONOLOR  
SONTEC  
SONY  
0190  
0235  
VOXSON  
WALTHAM  
WARDS  
0068  
0027, 0108, 0131  
0027  
0062  
0070, 0267  
0036, 0064  
0190, 0235  
0064  
0027, 0677, 0861,  
1127, 1532, 1678  
0205, 0207  
0064, 0445  
0078, 0087, 0119,  
0183, 0205  
0198  
0267, 0305  
0099  
WATSON  
WAYCON  
0064, 0347  
0183  
ELECTROHOME  
ELECTROPHONIC 0064  
EMEREX  
0064  
0027, 0267  
1305  
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE  
0064, 0347, 0490,  
SOUNDESIGN  
SOUNDWAVE  
SOWA  
0059  
0650  
EMERSON  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0070, 0072, 0211,  
0267, 0305, 1305,  
1506  
YAMAHA  
0057, 0172, 0677,  
0796, 0860,  
2900 (projector),  
2901 (projector),  
2903,  
2904 (projector)  
0277  
0064, 0291  
0044, 0119, 0205,  
0490  
MAGNIN  
0267  
MANESTH  
MARANTZ  
MARTA  
MATSUI  
MATSUSHITA  
MEDION  
0072, 0099  
0062, 0108  
0064  
0375, 0379  
0062  
SQUAREVIEW  
STANDARD 0036  
STARLITE  
STERN  
SUPREME  
SYLVANIA  
FERGUSON 0068, 0347  
FIDELITY 0027  
FINLANDIA 0108, 0131  
0207  
0190, 0286  
0027  
YAPSHE  
YOKO  
ZENITH  
FINLUX  
0027, 0069, 0108,  
0131  
0375  
0057, 0081, 0198  
MEMOREX  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0066, 0074, 0075,  
0131, 0267, 0334,  
0375, 1264  
0099  
SYMPHONIC 0198, 0207  
SYNCO  
FIRSTLINE  
0064, 0070, 0072,  
0099  
0074, 0131  
0060, 0062  
0027, 0072  
0027  
0062, 0087, 0267,  
0834, 1062, 1087  
0108  
0027, 0087, 0119,  
0120, 0205, 0478  
0064  
0474  
0835  
0205  
0044  
0490  
0036, 0119, 0205  
0036  
0120, 0190  
0119, 0677  
0036, 0064, 0078,  
0081, 0087, 0181,  
0183, 0543  
0036, 0064, 0291,  
0439, 0445, 0482,  
0695, 1064  
0274  
FISHER  
FUJI  
FUJITSU  
FUNAI  
GE  
SYSLINE  
T + A  
TCM  
TMK  
TNCI  
MEMPHIS  
METZ  
MINOLTA  
MITSUBISHI 0068, 0070, 0094,  
0108, 0834  
MOTOROLA 0062, 0075  
MULTITECH 0027, 0099  
MURPHY  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
VCR  
ASA  
ADMIRAL  
0064, 0374, 1589  
0069  
0064, 0108  
0075  
ADVENTURA 0027  
TVS  
AIKO  
AIWA  
0305  
GEC  
TACICO  
TAI YI  
TANDY  
TASHIKO  
TATUNG  
0027, 0064, 0334,  
0375, 0379  
0068, 0342  
0099  
0099, 0305, 0342,  
0379  
GARRARD  
GENERAL  
GO VIDEO  
GOLDHAND 0099  
GOLDSTAR 0064, 0252, 0507,  
1264  
GOODMANS 0027, 0064, 0099,  
0305  
GRADIENTE 0027  
0027  
0072  
0459  
0027  
0108  
0131  
0062, 0064, 0068,  
0075, 0094, 0131  
0253  
AKAI  
AKIBA  
ALBA  
NEC  
AMERICA ACTION 0305  
AMERICAN HIGH 0062  
NATIONAL  
NECKERMANN  
NESCO  
NEWAVE  
NIKKO  
TEAC  
TEC  
TECHNEMA 0347  
TECHNICS  
0108  
AMSTRAD  
ANAM  
0027  
0064, 0253, 0267,  
0305, 0507  
0099  
0064  
0064  
0267  
GRAETZ  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0108, 0131  
0027, 0064, 0099  
0099, 0108, 0253,  
0374  
GRANADA  
GRANDIN  
GRUNDIG  
ANAM NATIONAL 0253, 1589  
NOBLEX  
NOKIA  
0078, 0277, 0677  
ANITECH  
ASHA  
ASUKA  
0099  
0267  
0064  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0068, 0347  
0027, 0068  
0342, 0375  
0062, 0253  
0064, 0075, 0131,  
0459  
0211, 0375, 0379,  
1506  
0027, 0064, 0099  
TECHWOOD 0078  
TECO  
NORDMENDE  
OCEANIC  
OKANO  
OLYMPUS  
OPTIMUS  
0036, 0078, 0119,  
0120, 0205, 0291,  
0680  
0081, 0087, 0119,  
0177, 0207  
0136, 0289,  
0362, 0652, 0729  
0347  
HCM  
HI-Q  
0099  
0074  
AUDIOVOX 0064, 0305  
BAIRD  
0027, 0068, 0131  
HANSEATIC 0064  
HARLEY DAVIDSON  
0027  
HARMAN/KARDON 0108  
HARWOOD  
HINARI  
TEKNIKA  
BASIC LINE 0099, 0305  
BEAUMARK 0267  
BELL & HOWELL 0131  
BLAUPUNKT 0253  
TELEFUNKEN  
ORION  
OSAKI  
0099  
TELEMEISTER  
TELETECH  
TENSAI  
TERA  
THOMSON  
BRANDT  
0347  
0099, 0267, 0379  
0027, 0064, 0068,  
0069, 0267  
0036  
0347  
0057  
BRANDT ELECTRONIC  
0068  
BROKSONIC 0211, 0375, 1506  
HITACHI  
OTTO VERSAND  
0108  
PALLADIUM 0064, 0068, 0099  
PANASONIC 0062, 0252, 0253,  
0643, 1062, 1589  
PATHE MARCONI 0068  
PENNEY  
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS  
0069  
HYPSON  
ITT  
ITV  
IMPERIAL  
INTERFUNK 0108  
JVC  
JENSEN  
KEC  
KLH  
0136, 0314, 0587,  
0652, 1474  
0064, 0131, 0388,  
0539  
0087, 0181, 0183,  
0535, 0645, 0677,  
0859, 1283, 1383,  
1683, 1731  
0543  
BUSH  
CCE  
CGE  
CALIX  
CANON  
CARVER  
CIMLINE  
CINERAL  
CITIZEN  
COLT  
0099, 0305, 0379  
0099, 0305  
0027  
0064  
0062  
0108  
0099  
0305  
0064, 0305, 1305  
0099  
0099  
THORN  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0064, 0305  
0027  
0062, 0064, 0069,  
0267, 1062, 1264  
0069  
0027  
0062  
0062, 0108, 0645,  
1108, 1208  
0108  
TOSHIBA  
PENTAX  
PERDIO  
PHILCO  
PHILIPS  
0068, 0072, 0094  
0068  
0064, 0305  
0099  
TRIUMPH  
TUNTEX  
0036, 0057, 0119  
PHONOLA  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PILOT  
PIONEER  
POLK AUDIO 0108  
PROFITRONIC  
PROLINE  
PROSCAN  
PROTEC  
PULSAR  
PYE  
0064  
0069, 0094, 0108  
TELEAVIA  
TELEFUNKEN  
TENOSAL  
TENSAI  
THOMAS  
THOMSON  
0068  
0068, 0347  
0099  
0027  
0027  
0068, 0087, 0094,  
0347  
0267  
0027  
0087, 1087  
0099  
0066  
0108  
THORN  
TIVO  
0068, 0131  
0645, 0663  
QUASAR  
QUELLE  
RCA  
0062, 1062  
0108  
0062, 0069, 0087,  
0267, 0834, 1062,  
1087  
TOSHIBA  
0068, 0070, 0072,  
0094, 0108, 0872  
TOTEVISION 0064, 0267  
UHER  
UNITECH  
0267  
0267  
RADIOSHACK  
RADIOLA  
RADIX  
0027  
UNIVERSUM 0027, 0064, 0108,  
0267  
0108  
0064  
0064  
VECTOR  
VICTOR  
0072  
0068, 0094  
RANDEX  
REALISTIC  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0074, 0075, 0131  
0375  
VIDEO CONCEPTS 0072  
VIDEOMAGIC  
0064  
REOC  
VIDEOSONIC 0267  
REPLAYTV  
REX  
ROADSTAR 0064, 0099, 0267,  
0305  
0641, 0643  
0068  
VILLAIN  
WARDS  
0027  
0027, 0062, 0069,  
0074, 0075, 0087,  
0099, 0108, 0267  
RUNCO  
SBR  
0066  
0108  
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE  
0099  
SEG  
SEI  
STS  
SABA  
SALORA  
SAMPO  
SAMSUNG  
SANKY  
SANSUI  
0267  
0108  
0069  
0068, 0347  
0070  
0064, 0075  
0072, 0267, 0459  
0066, 0075  
0027, 0068, 0094,  
1506  
XR-1000  
YAMAHA  
YAMISHI  
YOKAN  
YOKO  
0027, 0062, 0099  
0068  
0099  
0099  
0267  
0027, 0060, 0066,  
1506  
ZENITH  
SANYO  
SAVILLE  
0074, 0131, 0267  
0379  
SCHAUB LORENZ 0027, 0068,  
0131  
SCHNEIDER 0027, 0099, 0108  
SCOTT  
SEARS  
0070, 0072, 0211  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0069, 0074, 0131,  
1264  
SELECO  
SEMP  
0068  
0072  
SHARP  
0075, 0834  
0099, 0131  
0064, 0108, 0131  
0064  
SHINTOM  
SIEMENS  
SILVA  
SINGER  
SINUDYNE  
0072, 0099  
0108  
SONIC BLUE 0641, 0643  
SONTEC  
SONY  
0064  
0027, 0059, 0060,  
0062, 0663, 1259  
0375  
SUNKAI  
SUNSTAR  
0027  
SUNTRONIC 0027  
SYLVANIA 0027, 0062, 0108,  
0070, 1808  
SYMPHONIC 0027  
TMK  
0267  
TANDY  
TASHIKO  
TATUNG  
0027, 0131  
0027, 0064  
0027, 0068, 0072,  
0094, 0108  
TEAC  
0027, 0068, 0305,  
0334, 0669  
TECHNICS  
TECO  
0062, 0253  
0062, 0064, 0068,  
0075  
TEKNIKA  
0027, 0062, 0064  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Wharfedale Portable Speaker EM 9 User Manual
Whirlpool Ice Maker ECKMF 28 User Manual
Whistler Radar Detector Pro 58 73 User Manual
Wolfgang Puck Mixer BHM00240C User Manual
Xerox All in One Printer 4500 PS TR User Manual
Zanussi Cooktop 178023 User Manual
Zanussi Cooktop SC5412 User Manual
Zanussi Cooktop ZIT64X User Manual
Zanussi Microwave Oven ME1205B User Manual
Zanussi Range 285743 User Manual